blob: 9fb099937e061bb0f635e896c86f5dfd82b9b4c3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
632 running on the same host.
633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100666ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
669 keyword to see available options.
670
671 Example:
672 global
673 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
674
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100675ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
677 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300678 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100679 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
680 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
681 information.
682
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100683ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
685 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
686 keyword to see available options.
687
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100688ssl-server-verify [none|required]
689 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
690 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
691 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
694 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
695 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
696 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
697 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200698
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200699 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
700 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
701 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200702
703stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
704 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
705 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100706 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200707
708stats maxconn <connections>
709 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
710 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712uid <number>
713 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
714 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
715 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
716 one. See also "gid" and "user".
717
718ulimit-n <number>
719 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
720 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
721 option.
722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100723unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
724 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
725
726 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
727 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
728 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
729 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
730 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
731 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
732 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
733 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
734 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
735 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737user <user name>
738 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
739 See also "uid" and "group".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200741node <name>
742 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
743
744 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
745 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
746 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
747 traffic.
748
749description <text>
750 Add a text that describes the instance.
751
752 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
753 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
754 "<" and ">" characters.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758-----------------------
759
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200760max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
761 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
762 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
763 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
764 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
765 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
766 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
767 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
768 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770maxconn <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
772 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
773 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200774 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
775 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
776 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
777 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
778 below 500 in general).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200779
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200780maxconnrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100790maxcomprate <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300792 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100793 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
794 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
795 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
796 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
797 default value.
798
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100799maxcompcpuusage <number>
800 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
801 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
802 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
803 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
804 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
805 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
806 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
807 process down and from introducing high latencies.
808
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100809maxpipes <number>
810 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
811 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
812 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
813 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
814 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
815 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
816
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200817maxsessrate <number>
818 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
819 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
820 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
821 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
822 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
823 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
824 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
825 fairness.
826
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200827maxsslconn <number>
828 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
829 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
830 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
831 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
832 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
833 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
834 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
835
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200836maxsslrate <number>
837 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
838 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
839 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
840 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
841 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
842 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
843 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
844 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
845 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
846 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
847
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100848maxzlibmem <number>
849 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
850 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
851 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100852 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
853 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
854 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
855
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200856noepoll
857 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
858 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100859 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
861nokqueue
862 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
863 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
864 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
865
866nopoll
867 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
868 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100869 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100870 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100872nosplice
873 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
874 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
875 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100876 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100877 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
878 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
879 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
880 "option splice-response".
881
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300882nogetaddrinfo
883 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
884 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
885
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200886spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900887 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
888 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
889 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
890 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
891 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
892 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200893
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200894tune.bufsize <number>
895 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
896 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
897 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
898 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
899 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
900 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
901 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
902 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400903 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
904 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
905 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200906
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200907tune.chksize <number>
908 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
909 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
910 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
911 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
912 checks whenever possible.
913
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100914tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
915 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
916 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
917 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
918 this value. The default value is 1.
919
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100920tune.http.cookielen <number>
921 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
922 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
923 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
924 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
925 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
926 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
927 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
928 to change this value.
929
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200930tune.http.maxhdr <number>
931 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
932 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
933 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
934 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
935 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
936 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
937 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
938 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
939 limit too high.
940
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100941tune.idletimer <timeout>
942 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
943 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
944 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
945 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
946 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
947 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
948 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
949 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
950 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
951
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100952tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100953 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
954 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
955 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
956 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
957 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
958 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
959 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
960 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
961 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
962 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100963
964tune.maxpollevents <number>
965 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
966 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
967 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
968 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
969 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
970
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200971tune.maxrewrite <number>
972 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
973 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
974 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
975 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
976 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
977 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
978 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
979 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
980 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
981 bufsize.
982
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200983tune.pipesize <number>
984 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
985 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
986 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
987 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
988 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
989 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
990
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100991tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
992tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
993 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
994 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
995 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
996 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
997 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
998 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
999 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1000
1001tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1002tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1003 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1004 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1005 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1006 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1007 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1008 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1009 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1010 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1011 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1012 notifying haproxy again.
1013
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001014tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001015 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1016 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1017 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001018 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001019 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1020 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1021 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1022 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1023 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001024 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1025 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001026
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001027tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1028 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1029 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1030 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1031 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1032 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1033 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1034
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001035tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1036 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001037 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001038 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1039 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1040 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1041 being used for too long.
1042
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001043tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1044 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1045 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1046 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1047 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1048 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1049 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1050 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1051 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1052 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1053 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001054 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1055 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001056
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001057tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1058 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1059 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1060 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1061 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1062 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1063 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1064 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1065 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1066
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001067tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1068 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001069 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001070 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1071 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1072 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1073
1074tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1075 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1076 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1077 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1078 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010803.3. Debugging
1081--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082
1083debug
1084 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1085 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1086 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1087 system startup.
1088
1089quiet
1090 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1091 line argument "-q".
1092
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010943.4. Userlists
1095--------------
1096It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1097http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1098it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1099
1100userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001101 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001102 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1103
1104group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001105 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001106 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1107 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1108
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001109user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1110 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001111 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1112 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001113 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1114 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001115 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001116 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001117
1118
1119 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001120 userlist L1
1121 group G1 users tiger,scott
1122 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001123
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001124 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1125 user scott insecure-password elgato
1126 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001127
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001128 userlist L2
1129 group G1
1130 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001131
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001132 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1133 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1134 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001135
1136 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001138
11393.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001140----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001141It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1142haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1143pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1144identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1145or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1146Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1147known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1148the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1149process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1150during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1151tables.
1152
1153peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001154 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001155 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1156
1157peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1158 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1159 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1160 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1161 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1162 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1163 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1164
1165 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1166 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1167
1168 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1169 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1170 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1171 across all peers.
1172
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001173 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1174 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1175 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1176
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001177 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001178 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001179 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1180 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1181 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001182
1183 backend mybackend
1184 mode tcp
1185 balance roundrobin
1186 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1187 stick on src
1188
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001189 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1190 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001191
1192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001194----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001195
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001196Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1197 - defaults <name>
1198 - frontend <name>
1199 - backend <name>
1200 - listen <name>
1201
1202A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1203its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1204section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001205section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001206
1207A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1208connections.
1209
1210A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1211to forward incoming connections.
1212
1213A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1214parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1215
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001216All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1217'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1218case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1219
1220Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1221logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1222proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1223However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1224name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1225
1226Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1227and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001228bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1230modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1231arbitrary criteria.
1232
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001233In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1234a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1235the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1236
1237 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1238 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1239 between responses and new requests.
1240
1241 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1242 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1243 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1244 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1245
1246 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1247 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1248 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1249
1250 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1251 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1252 client-facing connection remains open.
1253
1254 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1255 after the end of the response.
1256
1257The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1258frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1259following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1260weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1261
1262 Backend mode
1263
1264 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1265 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1266 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1267 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1268 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1269 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1270 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1271 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1272 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1273 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1274 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001276
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012784.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1279--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001281The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1282limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1283they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1284limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001285marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001286option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001287and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1288with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1289specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001290
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001291
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001292 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1293------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1294acl - X X X
1295appsession - - X X
1296backlog X X X -
1297balance X - X X
1298bind - X X -
1299bind-process X X X X
1300block - X X X
1301capture cookie - X X -
1302capture request header - X X -
1303capture response header - X X -
1304clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001305compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1307cookie X - X X
1308default-server X - X X
1309default_backend X X X -
1310description - X X X
1311disabled X X X X
1312dispatch - - X X
1313enabled X X X X
1314errorfile X X X X
1315errorloc X X X X
1316errorloc302 X X X X
1317-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1318errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001319force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320fullconn X - X X
1321grace X X X X
1322hash-type X - X X
1323http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001324http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001325http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001326http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001327http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001328http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001329id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001330ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001331log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001332max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001333maxconn X X X -
1334mode X X X X
1335monitor fail - X X -
1336monitor-net X X X -
1337monitor-uri X X X -
1338option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1339option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1340option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1341option allbackups (*) X - X X
1342option checkcache (*) X - X X
1343option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1344option contstats (*) X X X -
1345option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1346option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1347option forceclose (*) X X X X
1348-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1349option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001350option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001351option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001352option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001353option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001354option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001355option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1356option httpchk X - X X
1357option httpclose (*) X X X X
1358option httplog X X X X
1359option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001360option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001361option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001362option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001363option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1364option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1365option logasap (*) X X X -
1366option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001367option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001368option nolinger (*) X X X X
1369option originalto X X X X
1370option persist (*) X - X X
1371option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001372option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001373option smtpchk X - X X
1374option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1375option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1376option splice-request (*) X X X X
1377option splice-response (*) X X X X
1378option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1379option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1380-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001381option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001382option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1383option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1384option tcpka X X X X
1385option tcplog X X X X
1386option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001387external-check command X - X X
1388external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001389persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1390rate-limit sessions X X X -
1391redirect - X X X
1392redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1393redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1394reqadd - X X X
1395reqallow - X X X
1396reqdel - X X X
1397reqdeny - X X X
1398reqiallow - X X X
1399reqidel - X X X
1400reqideny - X X X
1401reqipass - X X X
1402reqirep - X X X
1403reqisetbe - X X X
1404reqitarpit - X X X
1405reqpass - X X X
1406reqrep - X X X
1407-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1408reqsetbe - X X X
1409reqtarpit - X X X
1410retries X - X X
1411rspadd - X X X
1412rspdel - X X X
1413rspdeny - X X X
1414rspidel - X X X
1415rspideny - X X X
1416rspirep - X X X
1417rsprep - X X X
1418server - - X X
1419source X - X X
1420srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001421stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001422stats auth X - X X
1423stats enable X - X X
1424stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001425stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001426stats realm X - X X
1427stats refresh X - X X
1428stats scope X - X X
1429stats show-desc X - X X
1430stats show-legends X - X X
1431stats show-node X - X X
1432stats uri X - X X
1433-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1434stick match - - X X
1435stick on - - X X
1436stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001437stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001438stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001439tcp-check connect - - X X
1440tcp-check expect - - X X
1441tcp-check send - - X X
1442tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001443tcp-request connection - X X -
1444tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001445tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001446tcp-response content - - X X
1447tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001448timeout check X - X X
1449timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001450timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001451timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1452timeout connect X - X X
1453timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1454timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1455timeout http-request X X X X
1456timeout queue X - X X
1457timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001458timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001459timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1460timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001461timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001463unique-id-format X X X -
1464unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001465use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001466use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001467------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1468 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014714.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1472---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001473
1474This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1475
1476
1477acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1478 Declare or complete an access list.
1479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1480 no | yes | yes | yes
1481 Example:
1482 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1483 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1484 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001486 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
1488
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001489appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1490 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1493 no | no | yes | yes
1494 Arguments :
1495 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1496 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1497
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001498 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001499 checked in each cookie value.
1500
1501 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1502 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1503 milliseconds.
1504
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001505 request-learn
1506 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1507 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1508 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1509 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1510 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1511 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1512
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001513 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1514 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1515 data following this prefix.
1516
1517 Example :
1518 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1519
1520 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1521 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1522
1523 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1524 2 modes are currently supported :
1525 - path-parameters :
1526 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1527 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1528 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1529 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1530 - query-string :
1531 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1532 query string.
1533
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1535 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1536 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1537 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001538 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1539 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1540 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001541 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1542 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1543
1544 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1545
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001546 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1547 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1548 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1549
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001550 Example :
1551 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1552
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001553 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1554 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001555
1556
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001557backlog <conns>
1558 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1560 yes | yes | yes | no
1561 Arguments :
1562 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1563 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001564 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001565
1566 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1567 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1568 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1569 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1570 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1571 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1572 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1573 backlog parameter.
1574
1575 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1576 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1577 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1578
1579 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1580
1581
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001582balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001583balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001584 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1586 yes | no | yes | yes
1587 Arguments :
1588 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1589 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1590 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1591 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1592
1593 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1594 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1595 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1596 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001597 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001598 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001599 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1600 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1601 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1602 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1603 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1604 it, so that you don't worry.
1605
1606 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1607 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1608 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1609 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1610 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1611 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1612 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1613 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001614
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001615 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1616 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1617 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1618 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1619 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1620 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1621 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1622 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1623
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001624 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001625 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001626 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1627 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001628 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001629 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1630 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1631 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1632 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1633 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001634 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1635 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1636 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1637 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1638 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1639 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1642 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1643 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1644 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1645 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1646 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1647 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1648 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001649 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001651 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1652 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1653 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001654
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001655 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1656 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1657 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1658 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1659 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1660 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1661 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1662 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1663 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1664 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1665 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1666 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001667
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001668 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001669 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1670 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1671 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1672 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1673 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1674 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1675 URIs start with a leading "/".
1676
1677 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1678 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1679 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1680 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001683 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1684
1685 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001686 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1687 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001688 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1689 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1690 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1691 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001692 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001693 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1694 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001695
1696 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1697 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1698 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1699 server will receive the request.
1700
1701 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1702 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1703 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1704 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1705 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001706 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1707 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1708 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001710 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1711 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1712 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1713 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1714 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001716 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001717 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1718 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1719 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1720
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001721 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1722 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1723 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1724
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001725 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001726 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001727 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1728 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1729 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1730 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1731 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1732 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001733 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001734 used instead.
1735
1736 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1737 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1738 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1739 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1740
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001741 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1742 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1743 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1744
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001745 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001748 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1749 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001750
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001751 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1752 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1753 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754
1755 Examples :
1756 balance roundrobin
1757 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001758 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001759 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1760 balance hdr(host)
1761 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001762
1763 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1764 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001766 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001767 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1768 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1769 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1770 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1771
1772 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1773 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1774 defaults to 16 kB.
1775
1776 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1777 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1778
1779 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1780 Round Robin.
1781
1782 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1783 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1784 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1785 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1786
1787 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1788
1789 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001790 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001791 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1792 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1793 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001795 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1796 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001797
1798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001799bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1800bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1803 no | yes | yes | no
1804 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001805 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1806 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1807 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1808 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001809 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001810 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1811 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1812 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1813 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1814 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1815 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1816 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001817 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1818 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1819 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1820 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1821 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1822 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1823 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001824 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1825 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1826 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001827 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1828 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1829 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1830 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001831
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001832 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1833 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001834 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1835 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1836 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001837 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1838 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1839 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1840 the range.
1841
1842 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1843 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1844 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1845 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1846 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1847 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1848 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001849 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001850 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001852 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1853 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1854 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1855 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1856 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1857 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1858 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1859 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1860
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001861 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1862 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1863 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1864 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001866 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1867 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1868 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1869 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1870 in a frontend.
1871
1872 Example :
1873 listen http_proxy
1874 bind :80,:443
1875 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001876 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001877
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001878 listen http_https_proxy
1879 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001880 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001881
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001882 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1883 bind ipv6@:80
1884 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1885 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1886
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001887 listen external_bind_app1
1888 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1889
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001890 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001891 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001894bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001895 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1897 yes | yes | yes | yes
1898 Arguments :
1899 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1900 may be used to override a default value.
1901
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001902 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001903 option may be combined with other numbers.
1904
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001905 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001906 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1907 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1908 missing from all processes.
1909
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001910 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001911 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001912 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1913 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1914 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1915 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001916
1917 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1918 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1919 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1920 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1921 and 'even' instances.
1922
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001923 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1924 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1925 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1926 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001927
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001928 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1929 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1930
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001931 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1932 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1933 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1934
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001935 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1936 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1937
1938 Example :
1939 listen app_ip1
1940 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001941 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942
1943 listen app_ip2
1944 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001945 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001946
1947 listen management
1948 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001949 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001950
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001951 listen management
1952 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1953 bind-process 1-4
1954
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001955 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001956
1957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001958block { if | unless } <condition>
1959 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 no | yes | yes | yes
1962
1963 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1964 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001965 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001966 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001967 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1968 "block" statements per instance.
1969
1970 Example:
1971 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1972 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1973 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1974 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001976 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977
1978
1979capture cookie <name> len <length>
1980 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1982 no | yes | yes | no
1983 Arguments :
1984 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1985 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1986 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1987 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1988 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1989
1990 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1991 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1992 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1993 right if it exceeds <length>.
1994
1995 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1996 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1997 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1998 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1999
2000 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2001 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2002 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2003
2004 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2005 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2006 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002007 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2008 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2009 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010
2011 Example:
2012 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2013
2014 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002015 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002016
2017
2018capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002019 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2021 no | yes | yes | no
2022 Arguments :
2023 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002024 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2026 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2027 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2028
2029 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2030 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2031 it exceeds <length>.
2032
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002033 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2035 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002036 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2037 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2038 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2039 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002040 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002041 environments to find where the request came from.
2042
2043 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2044 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2045 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2046 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002048 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2049 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2050 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2051 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2052 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002053
2054 Example:
2055 capture request header Host len 15
2056 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2057 capture request header Referrer len 15
2058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002059 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060 about logging.
2061
2062
2063capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002064 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2066 no | yes | yes | no
2067 Arguments :
2068 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002069 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2071 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2072 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2073
2074 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2075 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2076 it exceeds <length>.
2077
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002078 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002079 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2080 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2081 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002082 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2083 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2084 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2085 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002087 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2088 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2089 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2090 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2091 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
2093 Example:
2094 capture response header Content-length len 9
2095 capture response header Location len 15
2096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002097 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002098 about logging.
2099
2100
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002101clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002102 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2104 yes | yes | yes | no
2105 Arguments :
2106 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2107 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2108 as explained at the top of this document.
2109
2110 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2111 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2112 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2113 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2114 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2115 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2116 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2117 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002118 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2120 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2121
2122 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2123 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2124 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2125 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2126 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2127 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2128
2129 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2130 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2131
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002132 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2133 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002135compression algo <algorithm> ...
2136compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002137compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002138 Enable HTTP compression.
2139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2140 yes | yes | yes | yes
2141 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002142 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2143 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2144 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2145
2146 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002147 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002148 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2149 data.
2150
2151 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2152 support for zlib was built in.
2153
2154 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2155 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2156 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2157 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2158 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2159 in.
2160
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002161 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002162 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002163 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2164 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2165 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2166 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2167 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002168
2169 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2170 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2171 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2172 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2173 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002174 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2175 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2176 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2177 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2178 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002179 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2180 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002181
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002182 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002183 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2184 "Accept-Encoding" header
2185 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002186 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002187 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2188 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002189 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2190 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2191 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2192 "multipart"
2193 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2194 header
2195 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2196 and later
2197 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2198 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002199
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002200 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2201 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002202
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002203 Examples :
2204 compression algo gzip
2205 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002207contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002208 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2210 yes | no | yes | yes
2211 Arguments :
2212 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2214 as explained at the top of this document.
2215
2216 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002217 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002218 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2220 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2221 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2222 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2223
2224 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2225 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2226 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2227 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2228 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2229 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2230
2231 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2232 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2233 instead.
2234
2235 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2236 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2237
2238
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002239cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002240 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2241 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2244 yes | no | yes | yes
2245 Arguments :
2246 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2247 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2248 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2249 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2250 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2251 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2252 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2253 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2254 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2255
2256 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2257 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2258 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2259 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2260 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2261 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2262 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2263 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2264 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2265 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2266 "insert" and "prefix".
2267
2268 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002269 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002270
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002271 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002272 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2273 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2274 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2275 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2276 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2277 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2278 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2279 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2280 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2281 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002282
2283 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2284 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2285 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2286 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2287 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2288 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2289 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2290 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2291 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2292 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002293 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2294 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2295 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002296
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002297 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2298 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2299 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002300 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2301 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2302 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2303 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002304 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2305 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2306 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307
2308 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2309 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2310 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2311 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2312 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2313 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2314 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2315 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2316 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2317
2318 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2319 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2320 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2321 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2322 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2323 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2324 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2325 persistence cookie in the cache.
2326 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2327
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002328 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2329 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2330 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2331 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2332 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2333 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2334 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2335 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2336 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2337 they logout.
2338
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002339 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2340 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2341 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2342 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2343
2344 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2345 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2346 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2347 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2348 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2349 this attribute.
2350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002351 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002352 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002353 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2354 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2355 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2356 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2357 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2358 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002359
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002360 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2361 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2362 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2363 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2364 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2365 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2366 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2367 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2368 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2369 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2370 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2371 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2372 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2373 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2374 the site.
2375
2376 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2377 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2378 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2379 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2380 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2381 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2382 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2383 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2384 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2385 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2386 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2387 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2388 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2389 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2390 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2391 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2392
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002393 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2394 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2395 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2396 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002398 Examples :
2399 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2400 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2401 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002402 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002403
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002404 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002405 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002406
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002408default-server [param*]
2409 Change default options for a server in a backend
2410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2411 yes | no | yes | yes
2412 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002413 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2414 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2415 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2416 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002417
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002418 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002419 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2420
2421 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002422
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424default_backend <backend>
2425 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2427 yes | yes | yes | no
2428 Arguments :
2429 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2430
2431 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2432 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2433 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2434 will catch all undetermined requests.
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436 Example :
2437
2438 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2439 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2440 default_backend dynamic
2441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002442 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002445description <string>
2446 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2448 no | yes | yes | yes
2449 Arguments : string
2450
2451 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2452 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2453 it describes.
2454 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2455
2456
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457disabled
2458 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2460 yes | yes | yes | yes
2461 Arguments : none
2462
2463 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2464 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2465 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2466 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2467 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2468 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2469 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2470
2471 See also : "enabled"
2472
2473
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002474dispatch <address>:<port>
2475 Set a default server address
2476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2477 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002478 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002479
2480 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2481 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2482 during start-up.
2483
2484 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2485 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2486 possible with normal servers.
2487
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002488 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002489 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2490 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2491 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2492 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2493
2494 See also : "server"
2495
2496
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002497enabled
2498 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2500 yes | yes | yes | yes
2501 Arguments : none
2502
2503 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2504 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2505
2506 See also : "disabled"
2507
2508
2509errorfile <code> <file>
2510 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | yes
2513 Arguments :
2514 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002515 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
2517 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002518 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002520 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2521 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522
2523 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2524 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2525 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2526
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002527 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002529 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2530 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2531 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2532 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2533
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002534 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2535 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2536 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2537 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2538 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2539 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2540
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002541 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2542 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2543 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002544 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2546
2547 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2548
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002549 Example :
2550 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002551 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002552 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2553 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2554
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002555
2556errorloc <code> <url>
2557errorloc302 <code> <url>
2558 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2560 yes | yes | yes | yes
2561 Arguments :
2562 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002563 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002564
2565 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2566 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2567 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2568 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2569 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2570
2571 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2572 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2573 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2574
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002575 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2576
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002577 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2578 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2579 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2580 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2581 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2582 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2583 request.
2584
2585 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2586
2587
2588errorloc303 <code> <url>
2589 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2591 yes | yes | yes | yes
2592 Arguments :
2593 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2594 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2595
2596 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2597 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2598 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2599 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2600 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2601
2602 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2603 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2604 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2605
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002606 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002608 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2609 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2610 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2611 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002612 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002613
2614 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2615
2616
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002617force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2618 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2620 no | yes | yes | yes
2621
2622 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2623 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2624 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2625 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2626 marked down for maintenance operations.
2627
2628 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2629 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2630 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2631 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2632 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2633 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2634 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2635 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2636 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2637
2638 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2639 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2640 is used.
2641
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002642 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002643 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002644
2645
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002646fullconn <conns>
2647 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 yes | no | yes | yes
2650 Arguments :
2651 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2652 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2653
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002654 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002656 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002657 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2658 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2659 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2660 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2661 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002662 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002663
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002664 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2665 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002666 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2667 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2668 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002669
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002670 Example :
2671 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2672 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2673 # connections.
2674 backend dynamic
2675 fullconn 10000
2676 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2677 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2678
2679 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2680
2681
2682grace <time>
2683 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002685 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002686 Arguments :
2687 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2688 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2689 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2690
2691 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2692 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002693 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002694 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2695
2696 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2697 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2698 simplify it.
2699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002701hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002702 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2704 yes | no | yes | yes
2705 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002706 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2707 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002708
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002709 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2710 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2711 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2712 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2713 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2714 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2715 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2716 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2717 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2718 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002719
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002720 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2721 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2722 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2723 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2724 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2725 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2726 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2727 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2728 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2729 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2730 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2731 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2732 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002733 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2734 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002735
2736 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2737
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002738 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002739 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2740 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2741 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002742 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2743 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2744 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002745
2746 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2747 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002748 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2749 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2750 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2751 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2752
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002753 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2754 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2755 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2756 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2757 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2758 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2759 parameter.
2760
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002761 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2762
2763 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2764 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2765 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2766 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2767 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2768 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2769 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2770 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2771 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2772 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2773 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2774 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002775
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002776 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2777 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2778 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002779
2780 See also : "balance", "server"
2781
2782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002783http-check disable-on-404
2784 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002786 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787 Arguments : none
2788
2789 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2790 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2791 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2792 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2793 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2794 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2795 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2796 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002797 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2798 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2799 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2800
2801 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2802
2803
2804http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002805 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002808 Arguments :
2809 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2810 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002811 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002812 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2813 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2814 details on the supported keywords.
2815
2816 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2817 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2818 with the usual backslash ('\').
2819
2820 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2821 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2822 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2823 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2824 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2825
2826 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002827 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002828 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2829 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2830 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2831
2832 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002833 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002834 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2835 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2836 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2837 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2838
2839 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002840 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002841 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2842 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2843 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2844 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2845 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2846 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2847 trace).
2848
2849 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002850 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002851 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2852 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2853 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2854 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2855 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2856 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2857
2858 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2859 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2860 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2861 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2862 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2863 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2864 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2865 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2866
2867 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2868 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2869
2870 Examples :
2871 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002872 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002873
2874 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002875 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002876
2877 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002878 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002879
2880 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002881 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002883 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002884
2885
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002886http-check send-state
2887 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2889 yes | no | yes | yes
2890 Arguments : none
2891
2892 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2893 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2894 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2895 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2896 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2897
2898 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2899 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2900 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2901 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2902 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2903 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2904 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2905 checked in multiple backends.
2906
2907 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2908 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2909
2910 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2911 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2912 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2913 one fails.
2914
2915 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2916 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2917 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2918
2919 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2920 server's queue.
2921
2922 Example of a header received by the application server :
2923 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2924 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2925
2926 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2927
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002928http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002929 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002930 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002931 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2932 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002933 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2934 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2935 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2936 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02002937 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
2938 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002939 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002940 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002941 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2942
2943 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2944 no | yes | yes | yes
2945
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002946 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2947 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2948 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2949 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2950 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002952 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2953 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2954 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2955
2956 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2957 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2958 are evaluated.
2959
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002960 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2961 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2962 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2963 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2964 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2965 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2966 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2967 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2968 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002969 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002970 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2971
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002972 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2973 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2974 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2975 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2976 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2977
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002978 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2979 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2980 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002981 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2982 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002983
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002984 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2985 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2986 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2987 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2988 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2989 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2990 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2991 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2992
2993 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2994 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2995 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2996 external users.
2997
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002998 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2999 <name>.
3000
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003001 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3002 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3003 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3004 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3005 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3006 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3007 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3008 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3009
3010 Example:
3011
3012 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3013
3014 applied to:
3015
3016 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3017
3018 outputs:
3019
3020 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3021
3022 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3023
3024 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3025 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3026 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3027 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3028 header.
3029
3030 Example:
3031
3032 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3033
3034 applied to:
3035
3036 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3037
3038 outputs:
3039
3040 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3041
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003042 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3043 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3044 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3045 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3046 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3047 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3048 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3049 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3050
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003051 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3052 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3053 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3054 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3055 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3056 another equipment.
3057
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003058 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3059 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3060 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3061 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3062 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3063 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3064 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3065 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3066
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003067 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3068 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3069 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3070 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3071 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3072 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3073 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3074 admin privileges.
3075
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003076 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3077 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3078 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3079 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3080 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3081 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3082 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3083 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3084
3085 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3086 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3087 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3088 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3089 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3090 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3091
3092 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3093 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3094 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3095 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3096 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3097 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3098
3099 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3100 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3101 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3102 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3103 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3104 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3105 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3106 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3107 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3108
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003109 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3110 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3111 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3112 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3113 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3114 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3115 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3116 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3117 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3118 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3119 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3120 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3121
3122 These actions take one or two arguments :
3123 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3124 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3125 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3126 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3127
3128 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3129 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3130 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3131 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3132
3133 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3134 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3135 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3136 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3137 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3138 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3139 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3140 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3141
3142 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3143 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3144 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3145 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3146 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3147
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003148 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3149
3150 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3151 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3152 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3153 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003154
3155 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003156 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3157 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3158 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003159
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003160 http-request allow if nagios
3161 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3162 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3163 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003164
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003165 Example:
3166 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003167 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003168
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003169 Example:
3170 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3171 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3172 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3173 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3174 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3175 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3176 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3177 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3178 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3179
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003180 Example:
3181 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3182 acl add path /addacl
3183 acl del path /delacl
3184
3185 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3186
3187 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3188 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3189
3190 Example:
3191 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3192 acl setmap path /setmap
3193 acl delmap path /delmap
3194
3195 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3196
3197 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3198 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3199
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003200 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3201 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003202
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003203http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003204 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003205 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3206 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003207 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3208 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3209 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3210 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3211 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3212 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003214 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3215
3216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3217 no | yes | yes | yes
3218
3219 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3220 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3221 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3222 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3223 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3224 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3225
3226 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3227 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3228 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3229 current section.
3230
3231 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3232 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3233 rules are evaluated.
3234
3235 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3236 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3237 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3238 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3239 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3240 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3241 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3242
3243 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3244 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3245 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3246 external users.
3247
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003248 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3249 <name>.
3250
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003251 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3252 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3253 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3254 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3255 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3256 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3257 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3258 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3259
3260 Example:
3261
3262 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3263
3264 applied to:
3265
3266 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3267
3268 outputs:
3269
3270 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3271
3272 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3273
3274 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3275 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3276 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3277 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3278 header.
3279
3280 Example:
3281
3282 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3283
3284 applied to:
3285
3286 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3287
3288 outputs:
3289
3290 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3291
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003292 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3293 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3294 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3295 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3296 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3297 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3298 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3299 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3300
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003301 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3302 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3303 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3304 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3305 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3306 another equipment.
3307
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003308 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3309 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3310 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3311 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3312 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3313 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3314 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3315 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3316
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003317 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3318 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3319 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3320 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3321 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3322 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3323 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3324 admin privileges.
3325
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003326 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3327 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3328 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3329 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3330 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3331 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3332 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3333 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3334
3335 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3336 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3337 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3338 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3339 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3340 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3341
3342 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3343 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3344 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3345 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3346 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3347 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3348
3349 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3350 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3351 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3352 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3353 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3354 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3355 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3356 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3357 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3358
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003359 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3360
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003361 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003362 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3363 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3364 rules.
3365
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003366 Example:
3367 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3368
3369 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3370
3371 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3372 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3373
3374 Example:
3375 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3376
3377 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3378
3379 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3380 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3381
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003382 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3383 ACL usage.
3384
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003385
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003386http-send-name-header [<header>]
3387 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3388
3389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 yes | no | yes | yes
3391
3392 Arguments :
3393
3394 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3395
3396 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3397 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3398 is added with the header string proved.
3399
3400 See also : "server"
3401
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003402id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003403 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3405 no | yes | yes | yes
3406 Arguments : none
3407
3408 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3409 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3410 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003411
3412
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003413ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3414 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3415 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3416 no | yes | yes | yes
3417
3418 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3419 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3420 and running).
3421
3422 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3423 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3424 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003425 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003426 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3427
3428 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3429 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3430
3431 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3432 "unless" condition is met.
3433
3434 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3435
3436
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003437log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003438log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003439no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003440 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3442 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003443
3444 Prefix :
3445 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3446 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3447 prefix does not allow arguments.
3448
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003449 Arguments :
3450 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3451 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3452 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3453 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3454 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3455 parameter.
3456
3457 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3458 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3459
3460 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3461 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3462 standard syslog port).
3463
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003464 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3465 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3466 standard syslog port).
3467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003468 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3469 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3470 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3471 appropriately writeable).
3472
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003473 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3474 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3475 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3476 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3477
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003478 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3479 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3480 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3481 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3482 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3483 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3484 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3485 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3486 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3487 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3488 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3489
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003490 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3491
3492 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3493 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3494 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3495
3496 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3497 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3498 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003499 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3500 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3501 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3502 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3503 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003504
3505 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3506
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003507 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3508 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3509 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003510
3511 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3512 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3513 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3514 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3515
3516 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3517 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003518
3519 Example :
3520 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003521 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3522 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003523 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3524
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003525
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003526log-format <string>
3527 Allows you to custom a log line.
3528
3529 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003531
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003532max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3533 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3534 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 yes | no | yes | yes
3536
3537 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3538 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3539 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3540 servers.
3541
3542 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3543 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3544 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3545 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3546 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3547 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3548 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3549 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3550 picking a different server.
3551
3552 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3553 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3554 even if they have to be queued.
3555
3556 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3557 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3558
3559
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560maxconn <conns>
3561 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3563 yes | yes | yes | no
3564 Arguments :
3565 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3566 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3567 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3568 closes.
3569
3570 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3571 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3572 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3573 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3574 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3575 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3576 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3577 properly tuned.
3578
3579 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3580 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3581 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3582
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003583 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003585 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3586
3587
3588mode { tcp|http|health }
3589 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 yes | yes | yes | yes
3592 Arguments :
3593 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3594 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3595 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3596 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3597
3598 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3599 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3600 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3601 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3602 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3603
3604 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003605 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3606 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3607 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3608 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3609 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3610 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3611 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003612
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003613 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3614 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3615 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003617 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003618 defaults http_instances
3619 mode http
3620
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003621 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003622
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003623
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003624monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003625 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3627 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003628 Arguments :
3629 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3630 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003631 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3633 backend and its backup.
3634
3635 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3636 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3637 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3638 servers in a list of backends.
3639
3640 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3641 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3642 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3643 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3644 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3645 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3646 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003647 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3648 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003649
3650 Example:
3651 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003652 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003653 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3654 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3655 monitor-uri /site_alive
3656 monitor fail if site_dead
3657
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003658 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003659
3660
3661monitor-net <source>
3662 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3664 yes | yes | yes | no
3665 Arguments :
3666 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3667 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3668 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3669 followed by a mask.
3670
3671 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3672 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003673 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003674 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3675
3676 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3677 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3678 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3679 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003680 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3681 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3682 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003683
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003684 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3685 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3686 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3687 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3688 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3689 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003690
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003691 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3692 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003694 Example :
3695 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3696 frontend www
3697 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3698
3699 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3700
3701
3702monitor-uri <uri>
3703 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | yes | yes | no
3706 Arguments :
3707 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3708 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3709
3710 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3711 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3712 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3713 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3714 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3715 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3716 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3717 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3718
3719 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3720 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3721 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3722 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3723 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3724 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3725
3726 Example :
3727 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3728 frontend www
3729 mode http
3730 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3731
3732 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003735option abortonclose
3736no option abortonclose
3737 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | no | yes | yes
3740 Arguments : none
3741
3742 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3743 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3744 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3745 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003746 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003747 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3748 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3749 encountered while delivering the response.
3750
3751 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3752 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3753 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3754 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3755 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3756 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003757 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003758 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003759 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003760 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3761 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3762 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3763
3764 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3765 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3766 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3767 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3768 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3769 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3770 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3771 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003772 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003773
3774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3776
3777 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3778
3779
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003780option accept-invalid-http-request
3781no option accept-invalid-http-request
3782 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3784 yes | yes | yes | no
3785 Arguments : none
3786
3787 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3788 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3789 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3790 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3791 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3792 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3793 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3794 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003795 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3796 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3797 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3798 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3799 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3800 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003801
3802 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3803 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3804 been confirmed.
3805
3806 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3807 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003808 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3809 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003810 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3811
3812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3814
3815 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3816 stats socket.
3817
3818
3819option accept-invalid-http-response
3820no option accept-invalid-http-response
3821 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3823 yes | no | yes | yes
3824 Arguments : none
3825
3826 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3827 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3828 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3829 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3830 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3831 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3832 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3833 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3834 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3835
3836 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3837 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3838 been confirmed.
3839
3840 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3841 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3842 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3843 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3844
3845 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3846 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3847
3848 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3849 stats socket.
3850
3851
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003852option allbackups
3853no option allbackups
3854 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | no | yes | yes
3857 Arguments : none
3858
3859 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3860 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3861 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3862 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3863 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3864 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3865 order between the backup servers anymore.
3866
3867 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3868 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3869
3870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3872
3873
3874option checkcache
3875no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003876 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3878 yes | no | yes | yes
3879 Arguments : none
3880
3881 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3882 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003883 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003884 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3885 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003886 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003887
3888 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003889 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003890 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003891 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3892 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003893 to the client are :
3894 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003895 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003896 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003897 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3898 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3899 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3900 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3901 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3902 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3903 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3904 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3905 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3906 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3907 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3908
3909 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003910 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003911 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003912 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003913 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3914
3915 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3916 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003917 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003918 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3919
3920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3922
3923
3924option clitcpka
3925no option clitcpka
3926 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3928 yes | yes | yes | no
3929 Arguments : none
3930
3931 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3932 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3933 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3934 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3935
3936 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3937 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3938 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3939 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3940
3941 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3942 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3943 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3944 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3945 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3946
3947 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3948
3949 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3950 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3951 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3952
3953 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3954 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3955
3956 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3957
3958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959option contstats
3960 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3962 yes | yes | yes | no
3963 Arguments : none
3964
3965 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3966 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3967 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3968 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3969 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3970 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3971 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3972
3973
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003974option dontlog-normal
3975no option dontlog-normal
3976 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3978 yes | yes | yes | no
3979 Arguments : none
3980
3981 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3982 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3983 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3984 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3985 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3986 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3987 logged.
3988
3989 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3990 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3991 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003993 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003994 logging.
3995
3996
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003997option dontlognull
3998no option dontlognull
3999 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4001 yes | yes | yes | no
4002 Arguments : none
4003
4004 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4005 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4006 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4007 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4008 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4009 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4010 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4011
4012 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4013 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4014 would not be logged.
4015
4016 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4017 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004019 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004020
4021
4022option forceclose
4023no option forceclose
4024 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004026 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004027 Arguments : none
4028
4029 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4030 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4031 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4032 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4033 global session times in the logs.
4034
4035 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004036 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004037 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004038
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004039 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4040 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4041 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4042
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004043 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4044 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004045
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4048
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004049 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004050
4051
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004052option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004053 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 yes | yes | yes | yes
4056 Arguments :
4057 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4058 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004059 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004060 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004061
4062 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4063 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4064 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4065 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4066 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4067 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4068 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004069 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4070 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4071 possible that the client has already brought one.
4072
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004073 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004074 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004075 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4076 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004077 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4078 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004079
4080 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4081 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4082 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4083 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4084 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4085 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4086 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4087
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004088 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4089 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4090 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4091 are under the control of the end-user.
4092
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004093 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004094 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4095 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004096 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4097 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4098 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004099
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004100 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004101 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4102 frontend www
4103 mode http
4104 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4105
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004106 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4107 backend www
4108 mode http
4109 option forwardfor header X-Client
4110
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004111 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004112 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004113
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004114
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004115option http-keep-alive
4116no option http-keep-alive
4117 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4119 yes | yes | yes | yes
4120 Arguments : none
4121
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004122 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4123 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4124 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4125 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4126 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4127 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4128 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4129
4130 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4131 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004132 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4133 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4134 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4135 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4136 situations where this option may be useful :
4137
4138 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4139 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4140
4141 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4142 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4143
4144 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4145 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4146 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4147 request.
4148
4149 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4150 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004151 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4152 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4153 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004154
4155 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4156 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4157
4158 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4159 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4160 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4161 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4162 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4163 not set.
4164
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004165 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4166 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004167 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004168 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004169
4170 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004171 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4172 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004173
4174
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004175option http-no-delay
4176no option http-no-delay
4177 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4179 yes | yes | yes | yes
4180 Arguments : none
4181
4182 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4183 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4184 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4185 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4186 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4187 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4188 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4189 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4190 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4191 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4192 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4193 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4194 affected.
4195
4196 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4197 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4198 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4199 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4200 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4201 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4202 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4203 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4204 latency environments.
4205
4206
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004207option http-pretend-keepalive
4208no option http-pretend-keepalive
4209 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4211 yes | yes | yes | yes
4212 Arguments : none
4213
4214 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4215 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4216 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4217 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4218 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4219 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4220 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4221 consider the response complete.
4222
4223 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4224 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4225 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4226 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4227 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4228 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4229
4230 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4231 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4232 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4233 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4234 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4235 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4236 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4237
4238 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4239 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004240 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004241 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4242 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004243
4244 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4245 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4246
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004247 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4248 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004249
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004250
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004251option http-server-close
4252no option http-server-close
4253 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4255 yes | yes | yes | yes
4256 Arguments : none
4257
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004258 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4259 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4260 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4261 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4262 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4263 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4264 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4265 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4266 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4267 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4268 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4269 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4270 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4271 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4272 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4273 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004274
4275 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4276 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4277 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4278 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004279 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4280 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004281
4282 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4283 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004284 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4285 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004286 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4287 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004288
4289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4291
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004292 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004293 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4294 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004295
4296
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004297option http-tunnel
4298no option http-tunnel
4299 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4301 yes | yes | yes | yes
4302 Arguments : none
4303
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004304 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4305 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4306 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4307 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4308 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4309 "option http-tunnel".
4310
4311 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004312 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004313 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4314 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4315 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4316 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4317 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4318 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4319 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004320
4321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4323
4324 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4325 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4326 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4327
4328
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004329option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004330no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004331 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 yes | yes | yes | no
4334 Arguments : none
4335
4336 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4337 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4338 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4339 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4340 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4341 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4342 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4343
4344 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4345 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4346 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4347 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4348 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4349 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4350 request along its whole life.
4351
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004352 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4353 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4354 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4355 front of an existing proxy.
4356
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004357 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4358
4359 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4360 http-server-close".
4361
4362
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004363option httpchk
4364option httpchk <uri>
4365option httpchk <method> <uri>
4366option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4367 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4369 yes | no | yes | yes
4370 Arguments :
4371 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4372 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4373 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4374 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4375 ones.
4376
4377 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4378 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4379 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4380
4381 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4382 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4383 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4384 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4385 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4386
4387 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4388 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4389 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4390 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4391 the lack of any response.
4392
4393 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4394
4395 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4396 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4397 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4398
4399 Examples :
4400 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4401 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4402 backend https_relay
4403 mode tcp
4404 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4405 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4406
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004407 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4408 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4409 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004410
4411
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004412option httpclose
4413no option httpclose
4414 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4416 yes | yes | yes | yes
4417 Arguments : none
4418
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004419 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4420 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4421 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4422 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004423 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004424 "option http-tunnel".
4425
4426 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4427 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4428 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4429 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4430 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4431 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4432 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4433 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004434
4435 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004436 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004437 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4438 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4439 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4440 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4441 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004442
4443 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4444 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004445 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4446 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004447 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4448 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004449
4450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4452
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004453 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4454 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004455
4456
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004457option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004458 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4460 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004461 Arguments :
4462 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4463 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4464 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4465 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4466 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004467
4468 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4469 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4470 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4471 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4472 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4473 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4474 ports.
4475
4476 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4477
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004478 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4479 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4480 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4481 by default.
4482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004483 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004484
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004485
4486option http_proxy
4487no option http_proxy
4488 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4490 yes | yes | yes | yes
4491 Arguments : none
4492
4493 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4494 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4495 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4496 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4497 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4498
4499 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4500 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4501 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4502 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004503 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004504 be analyzed.
4505
4506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4508
4509 Example :
4510 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4511 backend direct_forward
4512 option httpclose
4513 option http_proxy
4514
4515 See also : "option httpclose"
4516
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004517
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004518option independent-streams
4519no option independent-streams
4520 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4522 yes | yes | yes | yes
4523 Arguments : none
4524
4525 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4526 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4527 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4528 receive data or not.
4529
4530 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4531 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4532 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4533 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4534 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4535 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4536 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4537 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4538 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4539 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4540 socket buffers.
4541
4542 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4543 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4544 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4545 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4546 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4547
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004548 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004549 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4550 deprecated.
4551
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004552 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004553
4554
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004555option ldap-check
4556 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 yes | no | yes | yes
4559 Arguments : none
4560
4561 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4562 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4563 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4564 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4565
4566 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4567 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4568
4569 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4570 configure it.
4571
4572 Example :
4573 option ldap-check
4574
4575 See also : "option httpchk"
4576
4577
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004578option external-check
4579 Use external processes for server health checks
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | no | yes | yes
4582
4583 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4584 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4585 command".
4586
4587 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4588
4589 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4590
4591
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004592option log-health-checks
4593no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004594 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4596 yes | no | yes | yes
4597 Arguments : none
4598
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004599 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4600 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4601 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004602
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004603 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4604 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4605 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4606 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4607 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4608
4609 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4610 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004611
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004612 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4613 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4614 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004615
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004616
4617option log-separate-errors
4618no option log-separate-errors
4619 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4621 yes | yes | yes | no
4622 Arguments : none
4623
4624 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4625 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4626 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4627 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4628 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4629 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4630 provides very important information.
4631
4632 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4633 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4634 error logs.
4635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004636 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004637 logging.
4638
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004639
4640option logasap
4641no option logasap
4642 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 yes | yes | yes | no
4645 Arguments : none
4646
4647 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4648 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4649 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4650 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4651 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4652 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4653 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004654 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004655 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4656 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4657
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004658 Examples :
4659 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4660 mode http
4661 option httplog
4662 option logasap
4663 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4664
4665 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4666 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4667 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4668 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004670 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004671 logging.
4672
4673
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004674option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004675 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4677 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004678 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004679 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4680 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004681 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004682
4683 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4684 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4685 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4686 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4687 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4688 in the MySQL table, like this :
4689
4690 USE mysql;
4691 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4692 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4693
4694 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4695 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4696 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4697 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4698 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4699 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4700 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4701 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4702 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4703
4704 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4705 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004706
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004707 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004708
4709 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4710 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4711 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4712 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4713 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4714 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4715
4716 See also: "option httpchk"
4717
4718
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004719option nolinger
4720no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004721 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004724 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004725
4726 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4727 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4728 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4729 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4730 connections.
4731
4732 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4733 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4734 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4735 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4736 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4737 this too.
4738
4739 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4740 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4741 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4742
4743 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4744 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4745 for servers.
4746
4747 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4748 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4749
4750
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004751option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4752 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4754 yes | yes | yes | yes
4755 Arguments :
4756 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4757 matching <network>
4758 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4759 header name.
4760
4761 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4762 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4763 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4764 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4765 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4766 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4767 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4768 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4769 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4770 possible that the client has already brought one.
4771
4772 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4773 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4774 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4775 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4776 header and requires different one.
4777
4778 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4779 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4780 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4781 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4782 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4783 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4784 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4785
4786 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4787 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4788 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4789 both are defined.
4790
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004791 Examples :
4792 # Original Destination address
4793 frontend www
4794 mode http
4795 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4796
4797 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4798 backend www
4799 mode http
4800 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4801
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004802 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4803 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004804
4805
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004806option persist
4807no option persist
4808 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004811 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004812
4813 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4814 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4815 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4816 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4817 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4818 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4819 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4820 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4821 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4822 redirected to another valid server.
4823
4824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4826
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004827 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004828
4829
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004830option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4831 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4833 yes | no | yes | yes
4834 Arguments :
4835 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4836 PostgreSQL server.
4837
4838 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4839 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4840 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4841 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4842
4843 See also: "option httpchk"
4844
4845
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004846option prefer-last-server
4847no option prefer-last-server
4848 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4849 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4850 yes | no | yes | yes
4851 Arguments : none
4852
4853 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4854 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4855 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4856 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4857 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4858 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4859 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4860 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4861 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004862 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4863 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4864 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4865 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4866 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4867 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4868 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004869
4870 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4871 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4872
4873 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4874
4875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004876option redispatch
4877no option redispatch
4878 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4880 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004881 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004882
4883 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4884 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4885 be able to access the service anymore.
4886
4887 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4888 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4889
4890 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4891 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4892 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004893
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004894 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4895 "redisp" keywords.
4896
4897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4899
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004900 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004901
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004902
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004903option redis-check
4904 Use redis health checks for server testing
4905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | no | yes | yes
4907 Arguments : none
4908
4909 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4910 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4911 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4912 find the "+PONG" response message.
4913
4914 Example :
4915 option redis-check
4916
4917 See also : "option httpchk"
4918
4919
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004920option smtpchk
4921option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4922 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4924 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004925 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004926 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4927 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4928 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4929
4930 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4931 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4932 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4933
4934 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4935 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4936 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4937 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4938 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4939 dead server.
4940
4941 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4942 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4943 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4944 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4945
4946 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4947 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4948 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4949 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4950 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4951
4952 Example :
4953 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4954
4955 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004957
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004958option socket-stats
4959no option socket-stats
4960
4961 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | no
4964
4965 Arguments : none
4966
4967
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004968option splice-auto
4969no option splice-auto
4970 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | yes | yes | yes
4973 Arguments : none
4974
4975 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4976 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4977 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4978 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004979 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004980 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4981 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4982 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4983 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4984
4985 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4986 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4987 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4988 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4989 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4990 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4991 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4992 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4993 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4994 keyword.
4995
4996 Example :
4997 option splice-auto
4998
4999 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5000 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5001
5002 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5003 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5004
5005
5006option splice-request
5007no option splice-request
5008 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 yes | yes | yes | yes
5011 Arguments : none
5012
5013 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005014 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005015 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5016 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5017 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5018 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5019
5020 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5021
5022 Example :
5023 option splice-request
5024
5025 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5026 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5027
5028 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5029 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5030
5031
5032option splice-response
5033no option splice-response
5034 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 yes | yes | yes | yes
5037 Arguments : none
5038
5039 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005040 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005041 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5042 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5043 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5044 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5045
5046 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5047
5048 Example :
5049 option splice-response
5050
5051 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5052 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5053
5054 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5055 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5056
5057
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005058option srvtcpka
5059no option srvtcpka
5060 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5062 yes | no | yes | yes
5063 Arguments : none
5064
5065 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5066 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5067 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5068 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5069
5070 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5071 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5072 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5073 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5074
5075 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5076 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5077 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5078 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5079 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5080
5081 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5082
5083 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5084 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5085 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5086
5087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5089
5090 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5091
5092
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005093option ssl-hello-chk
5094 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5096 yes | no | yes | yes
5097 Arguments : none
5098
5099 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5100 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5101 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5102 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5103 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5104 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5105 hello message.
5106
5107 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5108 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5109 messages, which is appreciable.
5110
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005111 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5112 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5113 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005114
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005115 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5116
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005117
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005118option tcp-check
5119 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5120 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5121 yes | no | yes | yes
5122
5123 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5124 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5125
5126 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5127 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5128 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005130 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005131 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5132 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5133 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5134 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5135 only.
5136
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005137 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005138 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5139 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5140 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5141 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5142
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005143 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005144 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5145 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005146 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005147 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5148 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5149 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5150 the respective protocols.
5151 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5152 analysed.
5153
5154 Examples :
5155 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5156 option tcp-check
5157 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5158
5159 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5160 option tcp-check
5161 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5162
5163 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5164 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005165 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005166 option tcp-check
5167 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5168 tcp-check expect +PONG
5169 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5170 tcp-check expect string role:master
5171 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5172 tcp-check expect string +OK
5173
5174 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5175 (send many headers before analyzing)
5176 option tcp-check
5177 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5178 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5179 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5180 tcp-check send \r\n
5181 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5182
5183
5184 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5185
5186
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005187option tcp-smart-accept
5188no option tcp-smart-accept
5189 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | yes | yes | no
5192 Arguments : none
5193
5194 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5195 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5196 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5197 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5198 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5199 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5200
5201 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5202 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5203 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5204 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5205
5206 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5207 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5208 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5209 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5210
5211 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5212 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5213 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5214
5215 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5216 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5217 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5218
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005219 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5220
5221
5222option tcp-smart-connect
5223no option tcp-smart-connect
5224 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | no | yes | yes
5227 Arguments : none
5228
5229 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5230 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5231 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5232 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5233 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5234
5235 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5236 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5237 complex.
5238
5239 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5240 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5241 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5242
5243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5245
5246 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5247
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005248
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005249option tcpka
5250 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5252 yes | yes | yes | yes
5253 Arguments : none
5254
5255 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5256 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5257 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5258 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5259
5260 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5261 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5262 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5263 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5264
5265 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5266 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5267 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5268 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5269 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5270
5271 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5272
5273 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5274 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5275 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5276 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5277 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5278 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5279 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5280 backends.
5281
5282 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5283
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005284
5285option tcplog
5286 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 yes | yes | yes | yes
5289 Arguments : none
5290
5291 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5292 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5293 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5294 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5295 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5296 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5297 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5298 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5299
5300 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005302 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005303
5304
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005305option transparent
5306no option transparent
5307 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005309 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005310 Arguments : none
5311
5312 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5313 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5314 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5315 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5316 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5317 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5318 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5319 appropriate server.
5320
5321 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5322 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5323
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005324 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005325 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005326
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005327
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005328external-check command <command>
5329 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5331 yes | no | yes | yes
5332
5333 Arguments :
5334 <command> is the external command to run
5335
5336 The PATH environment variable used when executing the
5337 command may be set using "external-check path".
5338
5339 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5340
5341 proxy_address proxy_port server_address server_port
5342
5343 The proxy_address and proxy_port are derived from the first listener
5344 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. It is an error for no such
5345 listeners to exist. In the case of a UNIX socket listener the
5346 proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the proxy_port will
5347 be the string "NOT_USED".
5348
5349 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5350 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5351 failed.
5352
5353 Example :
5354 external-check command /bin/true
5355
5356 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5357
5358
5359external-check path <path>
5360 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5362 yes | no | yes | yes
5363
5364 Arguments :
5365 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5366
5367 The default path is "".
5368
5369 Example :
5370 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5371
5372 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5373 "external-check command"
5374
5375
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005376persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005377persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005378 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5380 yes | no | yes | yes
5381 Arguments :
5382 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005383 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5384 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005385
5386 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5387 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5388 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5389 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5390 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5391 forwarded to this server.
5392
5393 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5394 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5395 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005396 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005397 a single "listen" section.
5398
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005399 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5400 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5401 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5402
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005403 Example :
5404 listen tse-farm
5405 bind :3389
5406 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5407 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5408 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5409 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5410 persist rdp-cookie
5411 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005412 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005413 balance rdp-cookie
5414 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5415 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5416
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005417 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5418 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005419
5420
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005421rate-limit sessions <rate>
5422 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5424 yes | yes | yes | no
5425 Arguments :
5426 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5427 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5428
5429 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5430 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5431 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5432 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5433 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5434 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5435
5436 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5437 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5438 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5439 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5440
5441 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5442 listen smtp
5443 mode tcp
5444 bind :25
5445 rate-limit sessions 10
5446 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5447
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005448 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5449 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5450 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005451
5452 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5453
5454
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005455redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5456redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5457redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005458 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 no | yes | yes | yes
5461
5462 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005463 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005464
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005465 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005466 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005467 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5468 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5469 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005470
5471 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5472 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5473 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5474 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5475 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005476 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5477 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5478 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5479 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005480
5481 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5482 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5483 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5484 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5485 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5486 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005487 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005488 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005489 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5490 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5491 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005492
5493 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005494 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5495 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5496 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5497 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5498 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5499 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5500 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5501 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005502
5503 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5504 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5505
5506 - "drop-query"
5507 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5508 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5509 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5510 with a location-type redirect.
5511
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005512 - "append-slash"
5513 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5514 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5515 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5516 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5517
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005518 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5519 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5520 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5521 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5522 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5523 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5524 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5525
5526 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5527 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5528 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5529 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5530 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5531 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5532 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005533
5534 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5535 acl clear dst_port 80
5536 acl secure dst_port 8080
5537 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005538 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005539 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005540 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5541
5542 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005543 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5544 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5545 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005546 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005547
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005548 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5549 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5550 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5551
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005552 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005553 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005554
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005555 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5556 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5557 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005559 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005560
5561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005562redisp (deprecated)
5563redispatch (deprecated)
5564 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5565 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5566 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005567 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005568
5569 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5570 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5571 be able to access the service anymore.
5572
5573 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5574 redistribute them to a working server.
5575
5576 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5577 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5578 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005580 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5581 "option redispatch" instead.
5582
5583 See also : "option redispatch"
5584
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005585
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005586reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005587 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 no | yes | yes | yes
5590 Arguments :
5591 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5592 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005593 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005594
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005595 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5596 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5597
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005598 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5599 the last header of an HTTP request.
5600
5601 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5602 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5603 responses.
5604
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005605 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5606 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5607 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5608
5609 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5610 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005611
5612
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005613reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5614reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005615 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5617 no | yes | yes | yes
5618 Arguments :
5619 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5620 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5621 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5622 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5623 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5624 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5625 ignores case.
5626
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005627 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5628 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5629
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005630 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5631 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5632 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5633 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005634 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005635
5636 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5637 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5638
5639 Example :
5640 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5641 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5642 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5643
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005644 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5645 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005646
5647
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005648reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5649reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005650 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 no | yes | yes | yes
5653 Arguments :
5654 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5655 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5656 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5657 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5658 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5659 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5660
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005661 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5662 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5663
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005664 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5665 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5666 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5667 next servers.
5668
5669 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5670 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5671 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5672
5673 Example :
5674 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5675 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5676 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5677
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005678 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5679 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005680
5681
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005682reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5683reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005684 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5686 no | yes | yes | yes
5687 Arguments :
5688 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5689 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5690 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5691 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5692 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5693 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5694 case.
5695
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005696 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5697 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5698
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005699 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5700 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5701 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5702 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005703 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005704
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005705 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005706 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005707 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005708
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005709 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5710 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5711
5712 Example :
5713 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5714 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5715 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5716
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005717 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5718 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005719
5720
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005721reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5722reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005723 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5725 no | yes | yes | yes
5726 Arguments :
5727 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5728 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5729 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5730 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5731 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5732 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5733 case.
5734
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005735 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5736 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5737
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005738 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5739 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5740 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5741 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5742
5743 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5744 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5745
5746 Example :
5747 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5748 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5749 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5750 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5751
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005752 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5753 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005754
5755
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005756reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5757reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005758 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 no | yes | yes | yes
5761 Arguments :
5762 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5763 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5764 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5765 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5766 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5767 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5768
5769 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5770 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5771 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5772 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005774
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005775 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5776 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5777
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005778 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5779 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5780 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5781
5782 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5783 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5784 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5785 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5786 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5787
5788 Example :
5789 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005790 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005791 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5792 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5793
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005794 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5795 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005796
5797
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005798reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5799reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005800 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5802 no | yes | yes | yes
5803 Arguments :
5804 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5805 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5806 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5807 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5808 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5809 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5810 ignores case.
5811
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005812 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5813 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5814
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005815 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5816 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005817 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5818 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5819 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005820 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5821 not set.
5822
5823 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5824 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5825 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5826 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5827 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5828
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005829 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005830 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5831 # block all others.
5832 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5833 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5834
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005835 # block bad guys
5836 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5837 reqitarpit . if badguys
5838
5839 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5840 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005841
5842
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005843retries <value>
5844 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5845 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5846 yes | no | yes | yes
5847 Arguments :
5848 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5849 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5850 default value is 3.
5851
5852 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5853 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5854 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5855
5856 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5857 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5858
5859 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5860 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5861
5862 See also : "option redispatch"
5863
5864
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005865rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005866 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5868 no | yes | yes | yes
5869 Arguments :
5870 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5871 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005872 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005873
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005874 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5875 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5876
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005877 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5878 the last header of an HTTP response.
5879
5880 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5881 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5882 responses.
5883
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005884 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5885 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005886
5887
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005888rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5889rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005890 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 no | yes | yes | yes
5893 Arguments :
5894 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5895 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5896 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5897 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5898 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5899 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5900 ignores case.
5901
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005902 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5903 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5904
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005905 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5906 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005907 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005908 client.
5909
5910 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5911 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5912 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5913
5914 Example :
5915 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005916 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005917
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005918 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5919 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005920
5921
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005922rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5923rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005924 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5926 no | yes | yes | yes
5927 Arguments :
5928 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5929 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5930 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5931 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5932 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5933 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5934 ignores case.
5935
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005936 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5937 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5938
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005939 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5940 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5941 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5942 case-sensitive.
5943
5944 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005945 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5946 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5947 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005948
5949 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5950 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5951
5952 Example :
5953 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5954 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5955
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005956 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5957 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005958
5959
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005960rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5961rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005962 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5964 no | yes | yes | yes
5965 Arguments :
5966 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5967 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5968 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5969 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5970 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5971 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5972 ignores case.
5973
5974 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5975 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5976 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5977 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005978 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005979
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005980 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5981 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5982
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005983 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5984 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5985 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5986
5987 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5988 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5989 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5990 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5991 are not case-sensitive.
5992
5993 Example :
5994 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5995 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5996
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005997 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5998 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005999
6000
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006001server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006002 Declare a server in a backend
6003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6004 no | no | yes | yes
6005 Arguments :
6006 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006007 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006008 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006009
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006010 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6011 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6012 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6013 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006014 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6015 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6016 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6017 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6018 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006019 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6020 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6021 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6022 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6023 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6024 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6025 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006026 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006027 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6028 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6029 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6030 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006031
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006032 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006033 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6034 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6035 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6036 adding this value to the client's port.
6037
6038 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6039 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006040 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006041
6042 Examples :
6043 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6044 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006045 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006046 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6047 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6048 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006049
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006050 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6051 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006052
6053
6054source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006055source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006056source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006057 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6059 yes | no | yes | yes
6060 Arguments :
6061 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6062 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006063
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006064 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006065 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6066 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6067 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6068 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6069 supported prefixes are :
6070 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6071 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6072 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006073 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006074 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6075 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6076 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6077 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006078
6079 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6080 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006081 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6082 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6083 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006084
6085 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6086 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6087 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6088 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6089 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6090 <addr>.
6091
6092 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6093 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6094 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6095 port.
6096
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006097 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6098 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6099 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6100 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006101 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006102 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6103 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6104 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6105 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6106 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6107 HTTP header.
6108
6109 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6110 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006111 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006112 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6113 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6114 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6115 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6116 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6117 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6118 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6119
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006120 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6121 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6122 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6123 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6124 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6125 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6126
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006127 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6128 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6129 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6130 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6131
6132 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6133 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6134 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6135 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6136 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6137 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6138
6139 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6140 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6141 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6142 there are two methods :
6143
6144 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6145 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6146 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6147 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6148 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6149 of the client ranges may be used.
6150
6151 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6152 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6153 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6154 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6155 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6156 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6157 same session.
6158
6159 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6160 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6161 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6162 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6163 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6164 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6165
6166 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6167 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6168 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006169 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006170
6171 Examples :
6172 backend private
6173 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6174 source 192.168.1.200
6175
6176 backend transparent_ssl1
6177 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6178 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6179
6180 backend transparent_ssl2
6181 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6182 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6183 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6184
6185 backend transparent_ssl3
6186 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6187 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6188 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6189
6190 backend transparent_smtp
6191 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6192 # with Tproxy version 4.
6193 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6194
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006195 backend transparent_http
6196 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6197 # proxy.
6198 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006200 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006201 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006203
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006204srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6205 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6207 yes | no | yes | yes
6208 Arguments :
6209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6211 as explained at the top of this document.
6212
6213 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6214 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6215 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6216 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6217 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6218 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6219 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6220
6221 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6222 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6223 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6224 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6225 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006226 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006227 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006228 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006229
6230 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6231 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6232 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6233 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6234 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6235 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6236
6237 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6238 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6239
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006240 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6241 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006242
6243
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006244stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6245 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006247 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006248
6249 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6250 matched.
6251
6252 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6253 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6254
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006255 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6256 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6257 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6258
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006259 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6260 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6261 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6262 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006263
6264 Example :
6265 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6266 backend stats_localhost
6267 stats enable
6268 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6269
6270 Example :
6271 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6272 backend stats_auth
6273 stats enable
6274 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6275 stats admin if TRUE
6276
6277 Example :
6278 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6279 userlist stats-auth
6280 group admin users admin
6281 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6282 group readonly users haproxy
6283 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6284
6285 backend stats_auth
6286 stats enable
6287 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6288 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6289 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6290 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6291
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006292 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6293 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6294 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006295
6296
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006297stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6298 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006300 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006301 Arguments :
6302 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6303
6304 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6305
6306 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6307 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6308 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6309 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6310 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6311 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6312
6313 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6314 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6315 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006316 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006317
6318 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6319 report using "stats scope".
6320
6321 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6322 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6323 unobvious parameters.
6324
6325 Example :
6326 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6327 backend public_www
6328 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6329 stats enable
6330 stats hide-version
6331 stats scope .
6332 stats uri /admin?stats
6333 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6334 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6335 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6336
6337 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6338 backend private_monitoring
6339 stats enable
6340 stats uri /admin?stats
6341 stats refresh 5s
6342
6343 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6344
6345
6346stats enable
6347 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006349 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006350 Arguments : none
6351
6352 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6353 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6354 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6355 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6356 - stats auth : no authentication
6357 - stats scope : no restriction
6358
6359 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6360 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6361 unobvious parameters.
6362
6363 Example :
6364 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6365 backend public_www
6366 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6367 stats enable
6368 stats hide-version
6369 stats scope .
6370 stats uri /admin?stats
6371 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6372 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6373 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6374
6375 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6376 backend private_monitoring
6377 stats enable
6378 stats uri /admin?stats
6379 stats refresh 5s
6380
6381 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6382
6383
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006384stats hide-version
6385 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006387 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006388 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006389
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006390 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6391 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6392 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6393 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6394 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6395 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006397 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6398 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6399 unobvious parameters.
6400
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006401 Example :
6402 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6403 backend public_www
6404 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006405 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006406 stats hide-version
6407 stats scope .
6408 stats uri /admin?stats
6409 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6410 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6411 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006412
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006413 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6414 backend private_monitoring
6415 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006416 stats uri /admin?stats
6417 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006418
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006419 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006420
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006421
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006422stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6423 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6424 Access control for statistics
6425
6426 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6427 no | no | yes | yes
6428
6429 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6430 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6431 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6432 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6433 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6434 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6435
6436 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6437 instance.
6438
6439 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6440 about ACL usage.
6441
6442
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006443stats realm <realm>
6444 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006446 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006447 Arguments :
6448 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6449 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6450 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6451
6452 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6453 using a backslash ('\').
6454
6455 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6456 only related to authentication.
6457
6458 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6459 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6460 unobvious parameters.
6461
6462 Example :
6463 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6464 backend public_www
6465 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6466 stats enable
6467 stats hide-version
6468 stats scope .
6469 stats uri /admin?stats
6470 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6471 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6472 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6473
6474 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6475 backend private_monitoring
6476 stats enable
6477 stats uri /admin?stats
6478 stats refresh 5s
6479
6480 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6481
6482
6483stats refresh <delay>
6484 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006486 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006487 Arguments :
6488 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6489 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6490 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6491 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6492 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6493 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6494
6495 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6496 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6497 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6498 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6499
6500 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6501 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6502 unobvious parameters.
6503
6504 Example :
6505 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6506 backend public_www
6507 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6508 stats enable
6509 stats hide-version
6510 stats scope .
6511 stats uri /admin?stats
6512 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6513 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6514 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6515
6516 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6517 backend private_monitoring
6518 stats enable
6519 stats uri /admin?stats
6520 stats refresh 5s
6521
6522 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6523
6524
6525stats scope { <name> | "." }
6526 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006528 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006529 Arguments :
6530 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6531 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6532 section in which the statement appears.
6533
6534 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6535 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6536 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6537 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6538 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6539 exists.
6540
6541 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6542 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6543 unobvious parameters.
6544
6545 Example :
6546 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6547 backend public_www
6548 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6549 stats enable
6550 stats hide-version
6551 stats scope .
6552 stats uri /admin?stats
6553 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6554 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6555 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6556
6557 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6558 backend private_monitoring
6559 stats enable
6560 stats uri /admin?stats
6561 stats refresh 5s
6562
6563 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6564
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006565
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006566stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006567 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006569 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006570
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006571 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006572 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6573
6574 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6575 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6576
6577 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6578 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006579 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006580
6581 Example :
6582 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6583 backend private_monitoring
6584 stats enable
6585 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6586 stats uri /admin?stats
6587 stats refresh 5s
6588
6589 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6590 global section.
6591
6592
6593stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006594 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6596 yes | yes | yes | yes
6597 Arguments : none
6598
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006599 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006600 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6601 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6602 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6603 - IP (socket, server)
6604 - cookie (backend, server)
6605
6606 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6607 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006608 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006609
6610 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6611
6612
6613stats show-node [ <name> ]
6614 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006616 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006617 Arguments:
6618 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6619 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6620
6621 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6622 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006623 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006624
6625 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6626 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6627 unobvious parameters.
6628
6629 Example:
6630 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6631 backend private_monitoring
6632 stats enable
6633 stats show-node Europe-1
6634 stats uri /admin?stats
6635 stats refresh 5s
6636
6637 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6638 section.
6639
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006640
6641stats uri <prefix>
6642 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006644 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006645 Arguments :
6646 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6647 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6648 query string.
6649
6650 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6651 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6652 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6653 possible to reach it in the application.
6654
6655 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006656 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006657 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6658 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6659 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6660 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6661
6662 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6663 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6664 an address or a port to statistics only.
6665
6666 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6667 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6668 unobvious parameters.
6669
6670 Example :
6671 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6672 backend public_www
6673 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6674 stats enable
6675 stats hide-version
6676 stats scope .
6677 stats uri /admin?stats
6678 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6679 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6680 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6681
6682 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6683 backend private_monitoring
6684 stats enable
6685 stats uri /admin?stats
6686 stats refresh 5s
6687
6688 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6689
6690
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006691stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6692 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006694 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006695
6696 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006697 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006698 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6699 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6700 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6701
6702 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6703 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6704 the "stick-table" statement.
6705
6706 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6707 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6708 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6709 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6710 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6711
6712 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6713 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6714 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6715 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6716 transformation rules.
6717
6718 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6719 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6720 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6721 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6722 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6723 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6724 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6725
6726 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6727 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6728 ACL based conditions.
6729
6730 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6731 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6732 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6733 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6734
6735 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6736 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6737 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6738 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6739
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006740 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6741 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6742 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6743
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006744 Example :
6745 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6746 # last 30 minutes
6747 backend pop
6748 mode tcp
6749 balance roundrobin
6750 stick store-request src
6751 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6752 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6753 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6754
6755 backend smtp
6756 mode tcp
6757 balance roundrobin
6758 stick match src table pop
6759 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6760 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6761
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006762 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006763 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006764
6765
6766stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6767 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6769 no | no | yes | yes
6770
6771 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6772 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6773 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6774 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6775
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006776 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6777 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6778 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6779
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006780 Examples :
6781 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006782 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006783
6784 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6785 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6786 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6787
6788
6789 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6790 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6791 backend http
6792 mode http
6793 balance roundrobin
6794 stick on src table https
6795 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6796 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6797 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6798
6799 backend https
6800 mode tcp
6801 balance roundrobin
6802 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6803 stick on src
6804 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6805 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6806
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006807 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006808
6809
6810stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6811 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6813 no | no | yes | yes
6814
6815 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006816 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006817 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6818 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6819 server is selected.
6820
6821 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6822 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6823 the "stick-table" statement.
6824
6825 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6826 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6827 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6828 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6829 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6830 address.
6831
6832 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6833 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6834 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6835 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6836 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6837 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6838 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6839 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6840 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6841 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6842
6843 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6844 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6845 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6846 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6847 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6848 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6849 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6850
6851 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6852 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6853 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6854 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6855
6856 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6857 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6858 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6859 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6860 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6861 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006862 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6863 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6864 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6865 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6866 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6867 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006868
6869 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6870 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6871 the request.
6872
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006873 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6874 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6875 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6876
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006877 Example :
6878 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6879 # last 30 minutes
6880 backend pop
6881 mode tcp
6882 balance roundrobin
6883 stick store-request src
6884 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6885 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6886 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6887
6888 backend smtp
6889 mode tcp
6890 balance roundrobin
6891 stick match src table pop
6892 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6893 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6894
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006895 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006896 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006897
6898
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006899stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006900 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6901 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006902 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006904 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006905
6906 Arguments :
6907 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6908 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6909 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6910 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6911
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006912 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6913 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6914 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6915 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6916
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006917 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6918 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6919 instance.
6920
6921 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6922 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6923 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6924 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6925 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6926 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006927 to 32 characters.
6928
6929 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6930 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6931 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006932 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006933 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6934 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006935
6936 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006937 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6938 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006939 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6940 increase.
6941
6942 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006943 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6944 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6945 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006946
6947 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6948 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6949 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6950 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6951 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6952 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6953 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6954 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6955 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6956 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6957 parameter (see below).
6958
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006959 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6960 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6961 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6962 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6963 soft restart.
6964
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006965 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6966
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006967 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6968 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6969 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6970 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6971 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006972 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006973 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6974 if not expiration delay is specified.
6975
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006976 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6977 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6978 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6979 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006980 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6981 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6982 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6983 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6984 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6985 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6986 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6987 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6988 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6989 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6990 types and their arguments.
6991
6992 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6993 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6994 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6995 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6996
6997 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6998 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6999 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7000 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7001
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007002 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7003 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7004 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7005 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7006 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7007 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7008
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007009 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7010 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7011 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7012 they were received.
7013
7014 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7015 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7016 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7017 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7018 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7019
7020 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7021 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7022 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7023 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7024 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7025
7026 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7027 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7028 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7029
7030 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7031 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7032 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7033 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7034 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7035
7036 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7037 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7038 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7039 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7040 the client side.
7041
7042 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7043 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7044 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7045 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7046 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7047 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7048 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7049
7050 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7051 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7052 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7053 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7054 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7055 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7056 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7057
7058 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7059 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7060 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7061 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7062 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7063 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7064
7065 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7066 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7067 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7068 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7069
7070 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7071 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7072 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7073 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7074 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7075 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7076 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7077 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7078 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7079 recommended for better fairness.
7080
7081 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7082 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7083 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7084 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7085
7086 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7087 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7088 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7089 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7090 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7091 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7092 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7093 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7094 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7095 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007096
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007097 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7098 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007099 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7100 reference it.
7101
7102 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7103 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7104 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7105 as an exclusive stickiness.
7106
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007107 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7108 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7109 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7110 something that can be ignored.
7111
7112 Example:
7113 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7114 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7115 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7116 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7117
7118 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007119 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007120
7121
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007122stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7123 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7125 no | no | yes | yes
7126
7127 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007128 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007129 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7130 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7131 server is selected.
7132
7133 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7134 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7135 the "stick-table" statement.
7136
7137 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7138 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7139 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7140 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7141
7142 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7143 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7144 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7145 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7146 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7147 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007148 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007149 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7150 rules.
7151
7152 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7153 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7154 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7155 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7156 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7157 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7158 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7159
7160 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7161 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7162 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7163 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7164
7165 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7166 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7167 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7168 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7169 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7170 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007171 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7172 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7173 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7174 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7175 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7176 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7177 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7178 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7179 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007180
7181 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7182
7183 Example :
7184 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7185 backend https
7186 mode tcp
7187 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007188 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007189 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007190
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007191 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7192 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7193
7194 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7195 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7196 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7197
7198 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7199 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007200
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007201 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7202 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7203 # at offset 44.
7204
7205 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7206 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7207
7208 # Learn on response if server hello.
7209 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007210
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007211 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7212 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7213
7214 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7215 extraction.
7216
7217
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007218tcp-check connect [params*]
7219 Opens a new connection
7220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7221 no | no | yes | yes
7222
7223 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7224 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7225 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7226
7227 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7228 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7229 of the sequence.
7230
7231 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7232 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7233 do.
7234
7235 Parameters :
7236 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7237 use the TCP connection.
7238
7239 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7240 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7241 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7242
7243 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7244
7245 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7246
7247 Examples:
7248 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7249 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7250 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7251 option tcp-check
7252 tcp-check connect
7253 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7254 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7255 tcp-check send \r\n
7256 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7257 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7258 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7259 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7260 tcp-check send \r\n
7261 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7262 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7263
7264 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7265 option tcp-check
7266 tcp-check connect port 110
7267 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7268 tcp-check connect port 143
7269 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7270 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7271
7272 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7273
7274
7275tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7276 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7278 no | no | yes | yes
7279
7280 Arguments :
7281 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7282 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7283 binary.
7284 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7285 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7286 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7287
7288 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7289 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7290 with the usual backslash ('\').
7291 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7292 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7293 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7294 used upper or lower case.
7295
7296
7297 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7298
7299 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7300 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7301 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7302 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7303 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7304 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7305 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7306 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7307
7308 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7309 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7310 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7311 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7312 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7313 expression.
7314
7315 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7316 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7317 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7318 this exact hexadecimal string.
7319 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7320
7321 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7322 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7323 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7324 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7325 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7326 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7327 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7328 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7329 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7330 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7331 the null character.
7332
7333 Examples :
7334 # perform a POP check
7335 option tcp-check
7336 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7337
7338 # perform an IMAP check
7339 option tcp-check
7340 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7341
7342 # look for the redis master server
7343 option tcp-check
7344 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7345 tcp-check expect +PONG
7346 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7347 tcp-check expect string role:master
7348 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7349 tcp-check expect string +OK
7350
7351
7352 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7353 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7354
7355
7356tcp-check send <data>
7357 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7358 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7359 no | no | yes | yes
7360
7361 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7362 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7363
7364 Examples :
7365 # look for the redis master server
7366 option tcp-check
7367 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7368 tcp-check expect string role:master
7369
7370 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7371 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7372
7373
7374tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7375 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7376 tcp health check
7377 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7378 no | no | yes | yes
7379
7380 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7381 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7382 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7383 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7384 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7385 hexadecimal string.
7386 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7387
7388 Examples :
7389 # redis check in binary
7390 option tcp-check
7391 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7392 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7393
7394
7395 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7396 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7397
7398
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007399tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7400 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7402 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007403 Arguments :
7404 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007405 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7406 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007407
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007408 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007409
7410 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7411 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007412 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7413 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7414 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7415 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7416 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7417 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007418
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007419 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7420 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7421 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7422 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007423
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007424 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007425 - accept :
7426 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7427 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7428 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007429
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007430 - reject :
7431 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7432 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7433 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7434 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7435 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7436 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7437 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7438 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7439 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7440 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7441 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7442 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007443
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007444 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7445 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7446 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7447 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7448 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7449 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7450 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7451 hosts.
7452
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007453 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7454 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7455 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7456 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7457 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7458 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7459 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7460 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7461 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7462 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7463 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7464
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007465 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007466 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007467 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007468 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007469 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7470 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007471 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007472 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7473 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7474 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7475 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7476 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007477
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007478 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007479 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007480 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007481 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7482 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7483 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7484 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007485
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007486 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7487 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7488 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7489 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007490
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007491 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7492 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7493 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7494 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7495 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007496 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7497 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7498 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7499 layer7 information is extracted.
7500
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007501 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7502 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7503 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7504 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7505 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007506
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007507 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7508 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7509 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007511 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7512 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7513 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007514
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007515 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007516 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007517 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007518
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007519 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7520 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7521 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007522
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007523 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007524 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7525 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007526
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007527 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7528
7529 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7530
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007531 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7532
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007533 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007534
7535
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007536tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7537 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007539 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007540 Arguments :
7541 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007542 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007543 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7544 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007545
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007546 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007547
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007548 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7549 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7550 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7551 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7552 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007553
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007554 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7555 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7556 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7557 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007558 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7559 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7560 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7561 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7562 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7563 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007564 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007565 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007567 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7568 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7569 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7570 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007571
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007572 Four types of actions are supported :
7573 - accept : the request is accepted
7574 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7575 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007576 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007578 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7579 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007580
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007581 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7582 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7583 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7584 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7585 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7586 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007588 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007589 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7590 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007591
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007592 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007593 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7594 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7595 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7596 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007597 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7598 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7599 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007600
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007601 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007602 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7603 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7604 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007605
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007606 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007607 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7608 # and reject everything else.
7609 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7610 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007611 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007612 tcp-request content reject
7613
7614 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007615 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7616 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7617 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007618 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007619
7620 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7621 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7622 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007623 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007624 tcp-request content reject
7625
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007626 Example:
7627 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7628 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007629 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007630
7631 Example:
7632 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7633 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007634 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007636 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7637 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7638
7639 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007640 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007641 # protecting all our sites
7642 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007643 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7644 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007645 ...
7646 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7647
7648 backend http_dynamic
7649 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007650 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007651 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007652 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7653 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7654 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007655 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007657 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007658
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007659 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007660
7661
7662tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7663 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007665 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007666 Arguments :
7667 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7668 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7669 as explained at the top of this document.
7670
7671 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7672 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7673 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7674 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7675 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7676
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007677 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7678 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7679 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7680 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7681
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007682 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7683 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007684 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007685 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007686 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7687 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7688 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7689 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007690
7691 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7692 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7693 it pass through unaffected.
7694
7695 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7696 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7697 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007698 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007699 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7700 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007701 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7702 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7703 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007704
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007705 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007706 "timeout client".
7707
7708
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007709tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7710 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 no | no | yes | yes
7713 Arguments :
7714 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007715 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007716
7717 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7718
7719 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7720 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7721 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007722 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7723 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007724
7725 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7726
7727 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7728 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7729 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7730 inserted.
7731
7732 Two types of actions are supported :
7733 - accept :
7734 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7735 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7736 the rules evaluation.
7737
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007738 - close :
7739 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7740 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7741 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7742 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7743 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7744 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007745 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007746 protocols.
7747
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007748 - reject :
7749 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7750 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007751 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007752
7753 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7754 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7755 for changing the default action to a reject.
7756
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007757 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7758 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7759 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7760 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007761 period.
7762
7763 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7764
7765 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7766
7767
7768tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7769 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7771 no | no | yes | yes
7772 Arguments :
7773 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7774 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7775 as explained at the top of this document.
7776
7777 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7778
7779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007780timeout check <timeout>
7781 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7782 established.
7783
7784 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7785 yes | no | yes | yes
7786 Arguments:
7787 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7788 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7789 as explained at the top of this document.
7790
7791 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7792 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7793 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7794 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007795 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7796 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7797 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007798
7799 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7800 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7801
7802 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7803 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007804 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007805
7806 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7807 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7808 forget about it.
7809
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007810 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7811 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007812
7813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007814timeout client <timeout>
7815timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7816 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7818 yes | yes | yes | no
7819 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007820 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007821 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7822 as explained at the top of this document.
7823
7824 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7825 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7826 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7827 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7828 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7829 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7830 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7831 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007832 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007833 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007834 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7835 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007836 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7837 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007838
7839 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7840 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7841 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7842 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7843 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7844 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7845
7846 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7847 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7848 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7849
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007850 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007851
7852
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007853timeout client-fin <timeout>
7854 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7856 yes | yes | yes | no
7857 Arguments :
7858 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7860 as explained at the top of this document.
7861
7862 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7863 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7864 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7865 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7866 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7867 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7868 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7869 down in one direction.
7870
7871 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7872 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7873 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7874
7875 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7876
7877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007878timeout connect <timeout>
7879timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7880 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7882 yes | no | yes | yes
7883 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7886 as explained at the top of this document.
7887
7888 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007889 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007890 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007891 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007892 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7893 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007894
7895 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7896 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7897 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7898 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7899 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7900 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7901
7902 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7903 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7904 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7905
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007906 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7907 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007908
7909
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007910timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7911 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7913 yes | yes | yes | yes
7914 Arguments :
7915 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7916 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7917 as explained at the top of this document.
7918
7919 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7920 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7921 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7922 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7923 once the request has started to present itself.
7924
7925 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7926 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7927 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7928 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7929 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7930
7931 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7932 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7933 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7934 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7935
7936 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7937 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7938 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7939 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7940 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007941 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007942
7943 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7944 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7945 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7946 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7947
7948 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7949
7950
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007951timeout http-request <timeout>
7952 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007954 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007955 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007956 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007957 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7958 as explained at the top of this document.
7959
7960 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7961 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7962 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7963 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7964 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7965 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7966 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007967 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7968 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7969 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7970 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7971 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7972 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7973 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007974
7975 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7976 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007977 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7978 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007979
7980 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7981 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7982 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7983 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7984 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7985
7986 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007987 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7988 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7989 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007990
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007991 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007992
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007993
7994timeout queue <timeout>
7995 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7997 yes | no | yes | yes
7998 Arguments :
7999 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8000 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8001 as explained at the top of this document.
8002
8003 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8004 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8005 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8006 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8007 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8008
8009 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8010 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8011 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8012 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8013
8014 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8015
8016
8017timeout server <timeout>
8018timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8019 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 yes | no | yes | yes
8022 Arguments :
8023 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8024 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8025 as explained at the top of this document.
8026
8027 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8028 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8029 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8030 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8031 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8032 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8033 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8034
8035 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8036 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8037 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8038 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8039 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008040 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008041 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008042 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8043 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8044 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8045 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008046
8047 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8048 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8049 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8050 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8051 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8052 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8053
8054 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8055 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8056 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8057
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008058 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008059
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008060
8061timeout server-fin <timeout>
8062 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8064 yes | no | yes | yes
8065 Arguments :
8066 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8067 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8068 as explained at the top of this document.
8069
8070 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8071 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8072 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8073 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8074 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8075 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8076 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8077 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8078 situations, it should not be needed.
8079
8080 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8081 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8082 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8083
8084 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8085
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008086
8087timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008088 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8090 yes | yes | yes | yes
8091 Arguments :
8092 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8093 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8094 as explained at the top of this document.
8095
8096 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8097 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8098 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8099
8100 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8101 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8102 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8103 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008104 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008105
8106 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8107
8108
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008109timeout tunnel <timeout>
8110 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8112 yes | no | yes | yes
8113 Arguments :
8114 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8115 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8116 as explained at the top of this document.
8117
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008118 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008119 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8120 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8121 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8122 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8123 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8124 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8125 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8126 specified.
8127
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008128 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8129 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8130 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8131 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8132 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8133 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8134 state.
8135
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008136 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8137 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8138 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8139 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8140 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8141
8142 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8143 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8144 forget about it.
8145
8146 Example :
8147 defaults http
8148 option http-server-close
8149 timeout connect 5s
8150 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008151 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008152 timeout server 30s
8153 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8154
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008155 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008156
8157
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008158transparent (deprecated)
8159 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008161 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008162 Arguments : none
8163
8164 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8165 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8166 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8167 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8168 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8169 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8170 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8171 appropriate server.
8172
8173 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8174
8175 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8176 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8177
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008178 See also: "option transparent"
8179
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008180unique-id-format <string>
8181 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8183 yes | yes | yes | no
8184 Arguments :
8185 <string> is a log-format string.
8186
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008187 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8188 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8189 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8190 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008191
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008192 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8193 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8194 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8195 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8196 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8197 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8198 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8199 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008200
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008201 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8202 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008203
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008204 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008205
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008206 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008207
8208 will generate:
8209
8210 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8211
8212 See also: "unique-id-header"
8213
8214unique-id-header <name>
8215 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 yes | yes | yes | no
8218 Arguments :
8219 <name> is the name of the header.
8220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008221 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8222 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008223
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008224 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008225
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008226 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008227 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8228
8229 will generate:
8230
8231 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8232
8233 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008234
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008235use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008236 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8238 no | yes | yes | no
8239 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008240 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8241 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008242
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008243 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8244 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008245
8246 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8247 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8248 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008249 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8250 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8251 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8252 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008253
8254 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8255 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8256 assign the backend.
8257
8258 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8259 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8260 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8261 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8262 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8263 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8264
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008265 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008266 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008267 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8268 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8269 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8270
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008271 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8272 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8273 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8274 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8275 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8276 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8277 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8278 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8279 cannot be forced from the request.
8280
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008281 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008282 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8283 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8284
8285 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8286 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008287
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008288
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008289use-server <server> if <condition>
8290use-server <server> unless <condition>
8291 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8293 no | no | yes | yes
8294 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008295 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008296
8297 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8298
8299 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8300 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8301 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8302
8303 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8304 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8305 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8306 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8307 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8308 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8309 matches will assign the server.
8310
8311 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8312 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8313 with the next rules until one matches.
8314
8315 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8316 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8317 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8318 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8319
8320 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8321 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8322 stripped.
8323
8324 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8325 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8326 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8327 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8328
8329 Example :
8330 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8331 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8332 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8333 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8334 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8335 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8336 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8337 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8338 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8339
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008340 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008342
83435. Bind and Server options
8344--------------------------
8345
8346The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8347depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8348settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8349written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8350described in this section.
8351
8352
83535.1. Bind options
8354-----------------
8355
8356The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8357as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8358no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8359parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8360while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8361provided immediately after the setting name.
8362
8363The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8364
8365accept-proxy
8366 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008367 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8368 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008369 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8370 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8371 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8372 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8373 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8374 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8375 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008376 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8377 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008378
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008379alpn <protocols>
8380 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8381 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8382 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8383 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8384 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8385 initial NPN extension.
8386
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008387backlog <backlog>
8388 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8389 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8390
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008391ecdhe <named curve>
8392 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008393 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8394 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008395
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008396ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8398 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8399 client's certificate.
8400
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008401ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8402 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8403 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8404 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8405 error is ignored.
8406
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008407ciphers <ciphers>
8408 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8409 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008410 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008411 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8412 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8413
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008414crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8416 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8417 to verify client's certificate.
8418
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008419crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008420 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8421 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8422 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8423 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8424 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8425 file.
8426
8427 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8428 are loaded.
8429
8430 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008431 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8432 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008433 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8434 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8435 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8436 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8437 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8438 www.sub.example.org).
8439
8440 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8441 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8442 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8443 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8444 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8445
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008446 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008447
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008448 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8449 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008450 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008451 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8452 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8453 clients).
8454
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008455 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8456 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8457 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8458 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8459 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8460 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8461 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8462 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8463 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8464 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8465 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8466 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8467 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8468
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008469crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008470 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8471 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008472 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008473 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008474
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008475crt-list <file>
8476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008477 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8478 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008479
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008480 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008481
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008482 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8483 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8484 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8485 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8486 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8487 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8488 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8489 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008490
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008491defer-accept
8492 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8493 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8494 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8495 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8496 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8497 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8498 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8499 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8500 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8501 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8502 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8503
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008504force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008505 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008506 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008507 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8508 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008509
8510force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008511 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008512 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8513 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008514
8515force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008516 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008517 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8518 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008519
8520force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008521 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008522 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8523 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008524
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008525gid <gid>
8526 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8527 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8528 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8529 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8530 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8531
8532group <group>
8533 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8534 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8535 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8536 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8537 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8538
8539id <id>
8540 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8541 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8542 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8543 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8544
8545interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008546 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8547 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8548 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8549 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8550 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8551 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8552 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008553
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008554level <level>
8555 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8556 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8557 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8558 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8559 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8560 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8561 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8562 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8563 counters).
8564 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8565 all counters).
8566
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008567maxconn <maxconn>
8568 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8569 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8570 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8571 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8572 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8573 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8574 eat all memory.
8575
8576mode <mode>
8577 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8578 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8579 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8580 UNIX sockets.
8581
8582mss <maxseg>
8583 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8584 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8585 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8586 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8587 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8588 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8589 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8590 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8591 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8592 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8593 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8594
8595name <name>
8596 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8597 page.
8598
8599nice <nice>
8600 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8601 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8602 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8603 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8604 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8605 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8606 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8607 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8608 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8609 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8610 one for an RDP socket.
8611
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008612no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008613 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008614 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008615 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008616 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8617 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008618 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008619
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008620no-tls-tickets
8621 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8622 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8623 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008624 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8625 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008626
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008627no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008629 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008630 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008631 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8632 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8633 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008634
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008635no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008637 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008638 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008639 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8640 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8641 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008642
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008643no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008645 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008646 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008647 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8648 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8649 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008650
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008651npn <protocols>
8652 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8653 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8654 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8655 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008656 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8657 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008658
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008659process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8660 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8661 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8662 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8663 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8664 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8665 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8666 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008667 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8668 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8669 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8670 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8671 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8672 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8673 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008674
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008675ssl
8676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008677 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008678 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8679 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8680 to deciphered contents.
8681
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008682strict-sni
8683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8684 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8685 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8686 See the "crt" option for more information.
8687
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008688tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008689 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008690 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8691 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8692 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8693 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8694 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8695 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8696 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008697 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8698 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8699 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008700
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008701transparent
8702 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8703 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8704 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8705 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8706 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8707 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8708 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8709 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8710 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8711 so check for support with your vendor.
8712
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008713v4v6
8714 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8715 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8716 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8717 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008718 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008719
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008720v6only
8721 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8722 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8723 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008724 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8725 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008726
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008727uid <uid>
8728 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8729 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8730 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8731 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8732 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8733
8734user <user>
8735 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8736 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8737 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8738 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8739 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8740
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008741verify [none|optional|required]
8742 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8743 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8744 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8745 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8746 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008747 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8748 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8749 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8750 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020087525.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008753------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008755The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8756which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8757arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8758settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8759after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8760Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8761address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008763 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008764 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008766The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008767
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008768addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008769 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8770 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8771 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8772 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8773 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008775 Supported in default-server: No
8776
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008777agent-check
8778 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008779 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8780 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8781 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8782 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008783
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008784 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008785 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008786 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8787 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8788 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008789
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008790 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8791 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008792
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008793 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8794 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8795 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008796
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008797 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8798 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8799 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008800
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008801 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8802 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8803 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8804 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8805 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8806 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8807 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008808
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008809 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8810 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008811
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008812 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8813 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8814 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8815 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8816 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8817 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8818 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8819 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8820 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008821
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008822 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8823 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008824 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8825 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8826 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8827 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008828
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008829 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8830 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008831
8832 Supported in default-server: No
8833
8834agent-inter <delay>
8835 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8836 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8837
8838 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8839 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8840 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8841 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8842 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8843 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8844 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8845 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8846 of backends use the same servers.
8847
8848 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8849
8850 Supported in default-server: Yes
8851
8852agent-port <port>
8853 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8854
8855 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8856
8857 Supported in default-server: Yes
8858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008859backup
8860 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8861 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8862 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8863 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8864 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8865 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008867 Supported in default-server: No
8868
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008869ca-file <cafile>
8870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8871 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8872 server's certificate.
8873
8874 Supported in default-server: No
8875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008876check
8877 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008878 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8879 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8880 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8881 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8882 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8883 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8884 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008885 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8886 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8887 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008889 Supported in default-server: No
8890
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008891check-send-proxy
8892 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8893 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8894 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8895 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8896 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8897 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8898 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8899
8900 Supported in default-server: No
8901
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008902check-ssl
8903 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8904 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8905 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8906 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008907 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008908 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8909 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8910 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8911 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8912
8913 Supported in default-server: No
8914
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008915ciphers <ciphers>
8916 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008917 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008918 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8919 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8920 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8921 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8922 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8923 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8924
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008925 Supported in default-server: No
8926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008927cookie <value>
8928 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8929 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8930 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8931 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8932 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8933 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8934 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008936 Supported in default-server: No
8937
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008938crl-file <crlfile>
8939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8940 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8941 to verify server's certificate.
8942
8943 Supported in default-server: No
8944
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008945crt <cert>
8946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8947 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8948 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8949 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8950 certificate request.
8951
8952 Supported in default-server: No
8953
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008954disabled
8955 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8956 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8957 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8958 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8959 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8960
8961 Supported in default-server: No
8962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008963error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008964 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8965 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8966 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008967
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008968 Supported in default-server: Yes
8969
8970 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008972fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008973 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8974 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8975 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008977 Supported in default-server: Yes
8978
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008979force-sslv3
8980 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8981 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008982 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8983 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008984
8985 Supported in default-server: No
8986
8987force-tlsv10
8988 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008989 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8990 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008991
8992 Supported in default-server: No
8993
8994force-tlsv11
8995 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008996 the server. This option is also available on global statement
8997 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008998
8999 Supported in default-server: No
9000
9001force-tlsv12
9002 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009003 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9004 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009005
9006 Supported in default-server: No
9007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009008id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009009 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9010 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9011 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009013 Supported in default-server: No
9014
9015inter <delay>
9016fastinter <delay>
9017downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009018 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9019 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9020 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9021 between checks depending on the server state :
9022
9023 Server state | Interval used
9024 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9025 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9026 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9027 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9028 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9029 or yet unchecked. |
9030 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9031 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9032 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009034 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9035 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9036 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9037 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009038 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9039 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9040 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9041 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9042 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009044 Supported in default-server: Yes
9045
9046maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009047 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9048 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9049 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9050 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9051 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9052 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9053 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9054 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009056 Supported in default-server: Yes
9057
9058maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009059 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9060 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9061 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9062 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9063 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9064 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9065 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009067 Supported in default-server: Yes
9068
9069minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009070 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9071 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9072 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9073 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9074 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9075 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009076 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009077 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009079 Supported in default-server: Yes
9080
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009081no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009082 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9083 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009084 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009085
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009086 Supported in default-server: No
9087
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009088no-tls-tickets
9089 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9090 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9091 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009092 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9093 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009094
9095 Supported in default-server: No
9096
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009097no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009098 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009099 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9100 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009101 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9102 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9103 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009104
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009105 Supported in default-server: No
9106
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009107no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009108 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009109 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9110 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009111 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9112 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9113 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009114
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009115 Supported in default-server: No
9116
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009117no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009118 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009119 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9120 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009121 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9122 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9123 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009124
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009125 Supported in default-server: No
9126
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009127non-stick
9128 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9129 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9130 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9131
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009132 Supported in default-server: No
9133
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009134observe <mode>
9135 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9136 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9137 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9138 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9139 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9140 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009141 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009142
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009143 Supported in default-server: No
9144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009145 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009147on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009148 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9149 Currently, four modes are available:
9150 - fastinter: force fastinter
9151 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9152 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9153 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9154 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009156 Supported in default-server: Yes
9157
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009158 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9159
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009160on-marked-down <action>
9161 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9162 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009163 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9164 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9165 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9166 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9167 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9168 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9169 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9170 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009171
9172 Actions are disabled by default
9173
9174 Supported in default-server: Yes
9175
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009176on-marked-up <action>
9177 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9178 Currently one action is available:
9179 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9180 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9181 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9182 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9183 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9184 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9185 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9186 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9187
9188 Actions are disabled by default
9189
9190 Supported in default-server: Yes
9191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009192port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009193 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9194 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9195 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9196 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9197 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9198 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9199
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009200 Supported in default-server: Yes
9201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009202redir <prefix>
9203 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9204 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9205 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9206 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9207 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9208 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9209 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9210 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009211 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009212 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9213 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9214 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9215 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9216 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9217
9218 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009220 Supported in default-server: No
9221
9222rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009223 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9224 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9225 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009227 Supported in default-server: Yes
9228
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009229send-proxy
9230 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9231 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9232 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9233 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9234 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9235 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9236 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9237 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9238 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009239 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9240 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9241 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9242 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9243 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009244
9245 Supported in default-server: No
9246
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009247send-proxy-v2
9248 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9249 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9250 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9251 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9252 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9253 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9254 option of the "bind" keyword.
9255
9256 Supported in default-server: No
9257
9258send-proxy-v2-ssl
9259 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9260 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9261 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9262 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9263 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9264 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9265 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9266 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9267
9268 Supported in default-server: No
9269
9270send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9271 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9272 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9273 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9274 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9275 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9276 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9277 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9278 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9279 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9280
9281 Supported in default-server: No
9282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009283slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009284 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9285 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9286 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9287 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9288 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9289 parameters :
9290
9291 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9292 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9293
9294 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9295 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9296 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9297 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9298
9299 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9300 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9301 seen as failed.
9302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009303 Supported in default-server: Yes
9304
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009305source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009306source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009307source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009308 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9309 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9310 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9311 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9312
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009313 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9314 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9315 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9316 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9317 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9318 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9319 server.
9320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009321 Supported in default-server: No
9322
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009323ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009324 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9325 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9326 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9327 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9328 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9329 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009330 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009331
9332 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009334track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009335 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9336 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9337 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9338 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009339 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009341 Supported in default-server: No
9342
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009343verify [none|required]
9344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009345 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9346 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9347 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9348 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009349 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9350 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9351 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009352
9353 Supported in default-server: No
9354
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009355verifyhost <hostname>
9356 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9357 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9358 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9359 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9360 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9361 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9362
9363 Supported in default-server: No
9364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009365weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009366 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9367 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9368 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009369 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9370 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9371 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9372 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9373 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9374 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009376 Supported in default-server: Yes
9377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009378
93796. HTTP header manipulation
9380---------------------------
9381
9382In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9383response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9384request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9385which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009386against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009387
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009388If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9389to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9390but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9391HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9392stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9393because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9394a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9395still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009397This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9398in section 4.2 :
9399
9400 - reqadd <string>
9401 - reqallow <search>
9402 - reqiallow <search>
9403 - reqdel <search>
9404 - reqidel <search>
9405 - reqdeny <search>
9406 - reqideny <search>
9407 - reqpass <search>
9408 - reqipass <search>
9409 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9410 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9411 - reqtarpit <search>
9412 - reqitarpit <search>
9413 - rspadd <string>
9414 - rspdel <search>
9415 - rspidel <search>
9416 - rspdeny <search>
9417 - rspideny <search>
9418 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9419 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9420
9421With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9422is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9423parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9424prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9425Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9426
9427 \t for a tab
9428 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9429 \n for a new line (LF)
9430 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9431 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9432 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9433 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9434 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9435
9436The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9437portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9438above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9439regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
94409 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9441is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9442
9443The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9444after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9445
9446Notes related to these keywords :
9447---------------------------------
9448 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9449 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9450 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9451
9452 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9453 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9454 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9455
9456 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9457 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9458 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9459 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9460 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9461
9462 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9463 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9464 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9465 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9466 useless headers before adding new ones.
9467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009468 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009469 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9470
9471 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9472 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9473 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9474
9475 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9476 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009477 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009478
9479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094807. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9481----------------------------------
9482
9483Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9484client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9485The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9486these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9487but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9488data called patterns.
9489
9490
94917.1. ACL basics
9492---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009493
9494The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9495content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9496from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9497simple :
9498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009499 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009500 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009501 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9502 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009504The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9505adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009506
9507In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009509 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009510
9511This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9512Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9513and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009514an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9515conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9516as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9517are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009518
9519ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9520'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9521which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9522
9523There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9524performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009526The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9527specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9528this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009529methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9530ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009531
9532Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9533 - boolean
9534 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9535 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9536 - string
9537 - data block
9538
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009539Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9540converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9541would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9542The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9543which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9544
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009545Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9546keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9547fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9548which are summarized in the table below :
9549
9550 +---------------------+-----------------+
9551 | Sample or converter | Default |
9552 | output type | matching method |
9553 +---------------------+-----------------+
9554 | boolean | bool |
9555 +---------------------+-----------------+
9556 | integer | int |
9557 +---------------------+-----------------+
9558 | ip | ip |
9559 +---------------------+-----------------+
9560 | string | str |
9561 +---------------------+-----------------+
9562 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9563 +---------------------+-----------------+
9564
9565Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9566matching method, see below.
9567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009568The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9569 - boolean
9570 - integer or integer range
9571 - IP address / network
9572 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9573 - regular expression
9574 - hex block
9575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009576The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9577
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009578 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9579 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009580 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009581 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009582 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009583 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009584 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009586The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9587read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9588if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9589lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9590will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9591beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9592a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9593lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9594exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9595
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009596The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9597parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9598ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9599a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9600check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9601
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009602The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9603socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9604file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009606Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9607loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9608
9609 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9610
9611In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9612the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9613case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9614as well.
9615
9616The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9617sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9618do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9619methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9620is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9621obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9622followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9623default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9624that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9625string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9626
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009627The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9628By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9629string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9630resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9631server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9632waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9633flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9634function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009636There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9637sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9638be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009639
9640 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9641 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009642 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9643 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9644 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9645 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009646
9647 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9648 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009649 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009650
9651 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009652 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009653
9654 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009655 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009656
9657 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9658 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9659
9660 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9661 binary or string samples.
9662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009663 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9664 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009666 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9667 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9668 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009670 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9671 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009673 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9674 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009676 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9677 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009679 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9680 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009681 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009683 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9684 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9685 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009686
9687For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9688request, it is possible to do :
9689
9690 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9691
9692In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9693buffer, one would use the following acl :
9694
9695 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9696
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009697On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9698possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9699
9700 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009702All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9703criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9704method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9705to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9706criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9707the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009709If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009710the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9711For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009713 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9714 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9715 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9716 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009717
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009718
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009719The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9720types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9721combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9722brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9723default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009725 +-------------------------------------------------+
9726 | Input sample type |
9727 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009728 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009729 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9730 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9731 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009732 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009733 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009734 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009735 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009736 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009737 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009738 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009739 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009740 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009741 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009742 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009743 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009744 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009745 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009746 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009747 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009748 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009749 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009750 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009751 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009752 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009753 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9754 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9755 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009756
9757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097587.1.1. Matching booleans
9759------------------------
9760
9761In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9762Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9763When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9764that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9765
9766Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9767return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9768"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020097717.1.2. Matching integers
9772------------------------
9773
9774Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9775enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9776to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9777
9778Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9779matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9780lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009781
9782For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9783unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9784representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9785
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009786As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9787two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9788instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9789ranges and operators.
9790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009791For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009792operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9793Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9794of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009795
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009796Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009797
9798 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9799 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9800 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9801 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9802 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9803
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009804For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009805
9806 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9807
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009808This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9809
9810 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9811
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098137.1.3. Matching strings
9814-----------------------
9815
9816String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9817different forms :
9818
9819 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9820 patterns ;
9821
9822 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9823 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9824
9825 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9826 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9827
9828 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9829 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9830
9831 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9832 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9833 matches.
9834
9835 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9836 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9837 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009838
9839String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9840exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9841characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9842string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9843to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009844before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009845
9846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098477.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9848---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009849
9850Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9851they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9852possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9853passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9854the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009855the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9856match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009857
9858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098597.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9860-------------------------------------
9861
9862It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9863not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9864a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9865to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9866digits may be used upper or lower case.
9867
9868Example :
9869 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9870 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9871
9872
98737.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9874---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009875
9876IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9877netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9878within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009879host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009880difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9881at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9882does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9883parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009884
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009885IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9886Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9887trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9888IPv6 patterns.
9889
9890HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9891following situations :
9892 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9893 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9894 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9895 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9896 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9897 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9898 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9899 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9900 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9901 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009903
99047.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9905----------------------------------
9906
9907Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9908combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9909
9910 - AND (implicit)
9911 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9912 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009914A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009916 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009918Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9919indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009921For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9922"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9923requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9924is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9925
9926 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9927 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9928 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9929 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9930
9931To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9932and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9933
9934 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9935 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9936 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9937 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9938
9939 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9940 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9941 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9942 use_backend www if host_www
9943
9944It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9945expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9946be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9947the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9948
9949 The following rule :
9950
9951 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9952 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9953
9954 Can also be written that way :
9955
9956 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9957
9958It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9959to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9960simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9961sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9962good use is the following :
9963
9964 With named ACLs :
9965
9966 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9967 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9968 monitor fail if site_dead
9969
9970 With anonymous ACLs :
9971
9972 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9973
9974See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9975
9976
99777.3. Fetching samples
9978---------------------
9979
9980Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9981against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9982sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9983ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9984of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9985available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9986
9987This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9988Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9989compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9990deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9991
9992The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9993matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9994method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9995indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9996
9997As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9998when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9999mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10000the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10001ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10002
10003Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10004multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10005when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10006incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10007are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10008is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10009all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10010
10011Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10012 - name
10013 - name(arg1)
10014 - name(arg1,arg2)
10015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010016
100177.3.1. Converters
10018-----------------
10019
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010020Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10021of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10022is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10023was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10024has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10025unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10026
10027These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10028sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10029the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10030support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010033
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010034base64
10035 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10036 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10037 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10038
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010039bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10040 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10041 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10042 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10043
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010044djb2([<avalanche>])
10045 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10046 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10047 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10048 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10049 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10050 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10051 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10052 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10053 directive.
10054
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010055field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10056 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10057 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10058 list of chars.
10059
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010060hex
10061 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10062 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10063 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10064 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010065
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010066http_date([<offset>])
10067 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10068 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10069 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10070 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10071 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10072 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010073
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010074in_table(<table>)
10075 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10076 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10077 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10078 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10079 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10080
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010081ipmask(<mask>)
10082 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10083 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10084 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10085 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10086
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010087json([<input-code>])
10088 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10089 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10090 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10091 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10092 of errors:
10093 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10094 bytes, ...)
10095 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10096 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10097
10098 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10099 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10100 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10101 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10102 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10103 are :
10104 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10105 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10106 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10107 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10108 error ;
10109 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10110 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10111
10112 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10113 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10114
10115 Example:
10116 capture request header user-agent len 150
10117 capture request header Host len 15
10118 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10119
10120 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10121 GET / HTTP/1.0
10122 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10123
10124 Output log:
10125 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10126
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010127language(<value>[,<default>])
10128 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10129 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10130 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10131 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10132 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10133 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10134 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10135 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10136 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10137 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10138 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10139 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010140
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010141 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010142
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010143 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10144 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010145
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010146 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10147 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10148 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10149 use_backend spanish if es
10150 use_backend french if fr
10151 use_backend english if en
10152 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010153
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010154lower
10155 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10156 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10157 type. The result is of type string.
10158
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010159ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10160 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10161 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10162 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10163 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10164 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10165 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10166
10167 Example :
10168
10169 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10170 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10171 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10172
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010173map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10174map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10175map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10176 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10177 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10178 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10179 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10180 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10181 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10182 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10183 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010184
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010185 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10186 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10187 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010188
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010189 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10190 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010191
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010192 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10193 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10194 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10195 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010196 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10197 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010198 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10199 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10200 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10201 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10202 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10203 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10204 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10205 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10206 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10207 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10208 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10209 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10210 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10211 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010212
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010213 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10214 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10215 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10216 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10217 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010218
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010219 Example :
10220
10221 # this is a comment and is ignored
10222 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10223 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10224 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10225 | | | `---------- value
10226 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10227 | `---------------------------- key
10228 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10229
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010230sdbm([<avalanche>])
10231 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10232 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10233 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10234 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10235 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10236 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10237 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10238 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10239 directive.
10240
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010241table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10242 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10243 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10244 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10245 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10246 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10247 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10248
10249
10250table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10251 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10252 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10253 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10254 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10255 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10256 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10257
10258table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10259 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10260 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10261 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10262 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10263 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10264
10265table_conn_cur(<table>)
10266 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10267 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10268 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10269 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10270 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10271
10272table_conn_rate(<table>)
10273 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10274 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10275 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10276 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10277 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10278
10279table_gpc0(<table>)
10280 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10281 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10282 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10283 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10284 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10285
10286table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10287 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10288 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10289 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10290 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10291 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10292 sample fetch keyword.
10293
10294table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10295 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10296 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10297 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10298 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10299 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10300
10301table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10302 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10303 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10304 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10305 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10306 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10307 keyword.
10308
10309table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10310 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10311 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10312 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10313 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10314 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10315
10316table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10317 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10318 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10319 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10320 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10321 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10322 keyword.
10323
10324table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10325 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10326 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10327 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10328 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10329 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10330 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10331 keyword.
10332
10333table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10334 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10335 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10336 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10337 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10338 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10339 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10340 keyword.
10341
10342table_server_id(<table>)
10343 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10344 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10345 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10346 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10347 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10348 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10349
10350table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10351 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10352 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10353 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10354 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10355 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10356 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10357 keyword.
10358
10359table_sess_rate(<table>)
10360 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10361 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10362 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10363 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10364 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10365 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10366 keyword.
10367
10368table_trackers(<table>)
10369 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10370 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10371 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10372 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10373 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10374 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10375 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10376 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10377 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10378 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10379
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010380upper
10381 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10382 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10383 type. The result is of type string.
10384
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010385utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10386 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10387 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10388 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10389 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10390 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10391 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10392
10393 Example :
10394
10395 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10396 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10397 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10398
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010399word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10400 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10401 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10402
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010403wt6([<avalanche>])
10404 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10405 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10406 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10407 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10408 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10409 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10410 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10411 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "sdbm", and the "hash-type"
10412 directive.
10413
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010414
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104157.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010416--------------------------------------------
10417
10418A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10419not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10420"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10421The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10422
10423always_false : boolean
10424 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10425 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10426
10427always_true : boolean
10428 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10429 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10430
10431avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010432 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010433 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10434 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10435 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10436 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10437 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10438 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10439 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10440 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10441 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10442 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10443 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10444 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10445 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010447be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010448 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10449 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10450 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10451 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10452 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010454be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10455 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10456 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10457 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10458 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10459 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10460 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010461
10462 Example :
10463 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10464 backend dynamic
10465 mode http
10466 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10467 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010469connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010471 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010472 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10473 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010474
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010475 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010476 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010477 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10478
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010479 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10480 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010481
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010482 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010483 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010484 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010485 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10486 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010487 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010488 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010489
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010490 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10491 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010492 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010493 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010494
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010495date([<offset>]) : integer
10496 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10497 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10498 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10499 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010500 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10501
10502 Example :
10503
10504 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10505 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010506
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010507env(<name>) : string
10508 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10509 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10510 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10511 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10512 certain way.
10513
10514 Examples :
10515 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10516 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10517
10518 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10519 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010521fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10522 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010523 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10524 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010525 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10526 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10527 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10528 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10529 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010531fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10533 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10534 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10535 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10536 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10537 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10538 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10539 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010540
10541 Example :
10542 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10543 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10544 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10545 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10546 frontend mail
10547 bind :25
10548 mode tcp
10549 maxconn 100
10550 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10551 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10552 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10553 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010554
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010555nbproc : integer
10556 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10557 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10558 and debugging purposes.
10559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010560nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10561 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10562 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10563 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010564 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10565 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10566 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010567
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010568proc : integer
10569 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10570 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10571 debugging purposes.
10572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010573queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010574 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10575 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10576 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10578 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10579 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10580 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10581 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10582
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010583rand([<range>]) : integer
10584 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10585 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10586 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10587 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10588 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010590srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10592 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10593 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10594 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10595 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10596 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10597 methods.
10598
10599srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10600 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10601 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10602 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10603 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10604 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10605 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10606 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10607
10608srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10609 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10610 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010611 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010612 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10613 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10614 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10615 overloading servers).
10616
10617 Example :
10618 # Redirect to a separate back
10619 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10620 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10621 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10622
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010623stopping : boolean
10624 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10625 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10626 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010628table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10629 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10630 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10631
10632table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10633 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10634 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10635 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10636
10637
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106387.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010639----------------------------------
10640
10641The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10642closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10643methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10644sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10645TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010646the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10647counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10648"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010649argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10650the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10651this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010652
10653be_id : integer
10654 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10655 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10656
10657dst : ip
10658 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10659 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10660 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10661 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10662 RFC 4291.
10663
10664dst_conn : integer
10665 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10666 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10667 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10668 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10669 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10670 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10671 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10672 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010674dst_port : integer
10675 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10676 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10677 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10678 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10679 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10680 an HTTP header.
10681
10682fe_id : integer
10683 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10684 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10685 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10686
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010687sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010688sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10689sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10690sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010691 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10692 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10693 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10694
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010695sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010696sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10697sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10698sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010699 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10700 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10701 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10702
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010703sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010704sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10705sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10706sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010707 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10708 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010709 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10710 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10711 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010712
10713 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10714 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010715 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10716 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10717 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010718 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10719 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10720
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010721sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010722sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10723sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10724sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010725 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10726 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10727
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010728sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010729sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10730sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10731sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010732 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10733 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10734 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010736sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010737sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10738sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10739sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010740 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10741 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10742 See also src_conn_rate.
10743
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010744sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010745sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10746sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10747sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010748 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010749 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010750
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010751sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010752sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10753sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10754sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010755 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10756 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10757 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010758 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10759 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10760 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010761
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010762sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010763sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10764sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10765sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010766 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10767 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10768 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010770sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010771sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10772sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10773sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010774 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10775 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10776 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10777 src_http_err_rate.
10778
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010779sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010780sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10781sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10782sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010783 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10784 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10785 src_http_req_cnt.
10786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010787sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010788sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10789sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10790sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010791 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10792 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10793 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10794 src_http_req_rate.
10795
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010796sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010797sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10798sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10799sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010800 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010801 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10802 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10803 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10804 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010805
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010806 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10807 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010808 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10809
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010810sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010811sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10812sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10813sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010814 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10815 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10816 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010817
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010818sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010819sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10820sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10821sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010822 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10823 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10824 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010826sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010827sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10828sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10829sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010830 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10831 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10832 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10833 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010834 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010835 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10836
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010837sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010838sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10839sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10840sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010841 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10842 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10843 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10844 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10845 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010846 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010847
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010848sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010849sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10850sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10851sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010852 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10853 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10854 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10855
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010856sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010857sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10858sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10859sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010860 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10861 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010862 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010863 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10864 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010865 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10866 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10867 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869so_id : integer
10870 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10871 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10872 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010874src : ip
10875 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10876 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10877 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10878 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10879 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10880 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10881 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010882
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010883 Example:
10884 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10885 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010887src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10888 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10889 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10890 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010891 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10894 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10895 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010896 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010897 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010899src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10900 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10901 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10902 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10903 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10904 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10905 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010906
10907 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10908 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10909 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10910 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010911 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010912 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10913 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010915src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010916 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010917 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010918 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010919 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010921src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010922 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010923 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10924 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010925 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010927src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10928 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10929 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10930 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010931 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010933src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010934 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010935 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010936 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010937 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010939src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010940 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010941 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010942 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10943 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010944 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10945 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10946 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010948src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10949 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10950 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010951 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010952 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010953 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010955src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10956 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10957 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10958 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10959 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010960 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010962src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10963 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10964 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10965 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010966 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10969 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10970 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10971 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010972 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010973 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010975src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10976 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10977 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10978 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010979 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10981 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010982
10983 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010984 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010985 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010987src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010988 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
10989 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
10990 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
10991 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
10992 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010994src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010995 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
10996 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10997 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
10998 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10999 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011001src_port : integer
11002 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11003 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11004 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11005 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011007src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11008 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011009 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11010 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11011 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011012 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011014src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11015 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11016 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11017 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11018 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011019 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011021src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11022 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11023 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11024 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11025 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11026 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11027 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11028 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11029 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011030
11031 Example :
11032 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11033 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11034 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11035 listen ssh
11036 bind :22
11037 mode tcp
11038 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011039 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011040 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011041 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011043srv_id : integer
11044 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11045 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11046 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011047
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011048
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110497.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011052The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11053closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11054when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11055usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011056future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011057
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011058ssl_bc : boolean
11059 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11060 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11061 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11062
11063ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11064 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11065 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11066
11067ssl_bc_cipher : string
11068 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11069 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11070
11071ssl_bc_protocol : string
11072 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11073 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11074
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011075ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011076 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011077 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11078 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011079
11080ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11081 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11082 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11083 if session was reused or not.
11084
11085ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11086 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11087 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11090 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11091 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11092 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11093 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11094 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011096ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11097 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11098 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11099 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11100 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011101
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011102ssl_c_der : binary
11103 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11104 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11105 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011107ssl_c_err : integer
11108 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11109 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11110 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11111 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11112 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011114ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11115 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11116 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11117 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11118 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11119 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11120 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11121 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11122 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011124ssl_c_key_alg : string
11125 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11126 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11127 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011129ssl_c_notafter : string
11130 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11131 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11132 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011134ssl_c_notbefore : string
11135 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11136 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11137 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011139ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11140 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11141 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11142 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11143 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11144 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11145 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11146 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11147 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011149ssl_c_serial : binary
11150 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11151 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11152 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011154ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11155 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11156 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11157 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011158 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11159 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11160
11161 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011163ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11164 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11165 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11166 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011168ssl_c_used : boolean
11169 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11170 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011172ssl_c_verify : integer
11173 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11174 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11175 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11176 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011178ssl_c_version : integer
11179 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11180 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011181
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011182ssl_f_der : binary
11183 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11184 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11185 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11188 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11189 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11190 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11191 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011192 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011193 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11194 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11195 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011197ssl_f_key_alg : string
11198 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11199 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11200 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011202ssl_f_notafter : string
11203 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11204 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11205 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011207ssl_f_notbefore : string
11208 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11209 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11210 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011212ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11213 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11214 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11215 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11216 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11217 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11218 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11219 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11220 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011222ssl_f_serial : binary
11223 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11224 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11225 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011226
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011227ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11228 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11229 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11230 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011232ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11233 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11234 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11235 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011237ssl_f_version : integer
11238 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11239 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11240
11241ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011242 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11243 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11244 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011246 Example :
11247 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11248 listen http-https
11249 bind :80
11250 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11251 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11252
11253ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11254 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11255 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11256
11257ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011258 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011259 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11260 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11261 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11262 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11263 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11264 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11265 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11266 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011268ssl_fc_cipher : string
11269 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11270 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011272ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011273 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11274 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011275 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11276 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11277 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11278 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011280ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11281 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011282 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11283 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11284 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11285 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011287ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011288 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011289 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11290 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11291 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11292 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11293 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11294 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11295 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011297ssl_fc_protocol : string
11298 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11299 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011300
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011301ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011302 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011303 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11304 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011306ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11307 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11308 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11309 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11310 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011312ssl_fc_sni : string
11313 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11314 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11315 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11316 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11317 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11318
11319 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11320 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11321 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011322 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11323 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011325 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011326 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11327 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011329ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11330 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11331 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011332
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200113347.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011335------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011337Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11338sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11339only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11340For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11341be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11342can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11343sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11344for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11345content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011347payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11348 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11349 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11350 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11353 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11354 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11355 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011357req.len : integer
11358req_len : integer (deprecated)
11359 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11360 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11361 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11362 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11363 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11364 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11365 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11366 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011368req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11369 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011370 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11371 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11372 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11373 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011375 ACL alternatives :
11376 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011378req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11379 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11380 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11381 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11382 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011384 ACL alternatives :
11385 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011387 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011389req.proto_http : boolean
11390req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11391 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11392 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11393 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11394 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11395 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11396 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11397 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011399 Example:
11400 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11401 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11402 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011403 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011405req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11406rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11407 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11408 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11409 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11410 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11411 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11412 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11413 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011415 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11416 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11417 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11418 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11419 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11420 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011422 ACL derivatives :
11423 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011425 Example :
11426 listen tse-farm
11427 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11428 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11429 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11430 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11431 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11432 persist rdp-cookie
11433 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11434 # This is only useful makes sense if
11435 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11436 stick-table type string size 204800
11437 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11438 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11439 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011441 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11442 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011444req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11445rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11446 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11447 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11448 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11449 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011451 ACL derivatives :
11452 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011454req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11455req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11456 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11457 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11458 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11459 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11460 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11461 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11462 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011464req.ssl_sni : string
11465req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11466 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11467 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11468 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11469 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11470 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11471 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11472 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11473 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11474 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11475 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11476 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11477 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011479 ACL derivatives :
11480 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011482 Examples :
11483 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11484 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11485 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11486 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11487 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011489res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11490rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11491 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11492 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11493 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11494 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11495 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11496 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11497 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011499req.ssl_ver : integer
11500req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11501 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11502 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11503 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11504 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11505 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11506 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11507 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11508 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11509 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011511 ACL derivatives :
11512 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011513
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011514res.len : integer
11515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11516 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11517 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11518 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11519 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11520 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11521 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11522 content inspection.
11523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011524res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11525 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011526 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11527 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11528 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11529 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011531res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11532 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11533 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11534 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11535 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011537 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011539wait_end : boolean
11540 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11541 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11542 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11543 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11544 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11545 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11546 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11547 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011549 Examples :
11550 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11551 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11552 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011554 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11555 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11556 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11557 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11558 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11559 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11560 tcp-request content reject
11561
11562
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200115637.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011564--------------------------------------
11565
11566It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11567This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11568data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11569its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11570HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11571content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11572to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11573more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11574response are indexed.
11575
11576base : string
11577 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11578 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11579 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11580 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11581 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11582 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11583 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11584 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11585
11586 ACL derivatives :
11587 base : exact string match
11588 base_beg : prefix match
11589 base_dir : subdir match
11590 base_dom : domain match
11591 base_end : suffix match
11592 base_len : length match
11593 base_reg : regex match
11594 base_sub : substring match
11595
11596base32 : integer
11597 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11598 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11599 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011600 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11601 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11602 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011603
11604base32+src : binary
11605 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11606 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11607 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11608 per-URL counters.
11609
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011610capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11611 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11612 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11613 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11614
11615capture.req.method : string
11616 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11617 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11618 because it's allocated.
11619
11620capture.req.uri : string
11621 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11622 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11623 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11624 allocated.
11625
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011626capture.req.ver : string
11627 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11628 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11629 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11630
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011631capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11632 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11633 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11634 The first entry is an index of 0.
11635 See also: "capture response header"
11636
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011637capture.res.ver : string
11638 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11639 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11640 persistent flag.
11641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011642req.cook([<name>]) : string
11643cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11644 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11645 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11646 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11647 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11648 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11649 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11650 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11651 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11652
11653 ACL derivatives :
11654 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11655 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11656 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11657 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11658 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11659 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11660 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11661 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011663req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11664cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11665 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11666 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011668req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11669cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11670 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11671 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11672 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11673 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011675cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11676 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11677 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11678 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11679 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11680 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11681 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11682 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11683 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11684 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11685 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011687hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11688 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11689 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11690 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11691 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011692 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011694req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11695 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11696 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11697 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11698 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11699 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11700 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11701 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11702 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011704req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11705 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11706 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11707 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11708 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011710req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11711 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11712 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11713 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11714 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11715 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11716 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11717 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11718 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11719 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11720 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11721 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011723 ACL derivatives :
11724 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11725 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11726 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11727 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11728 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11729 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11730 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11731 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11732
11733req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11734hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11735 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11736 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11737 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11738 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11739 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11740 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11741 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11742 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11743 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11744
11745req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11746hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11747 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11748 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11749 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11750 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11751 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11752 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11753 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11754 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11755
11756req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11757hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11758 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11759 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11760 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11761 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11762 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11763 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11764 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11765
11766http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11767 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11768 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11769 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11770 basic auth is supported.
11771
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011772http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11773 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11774 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11775 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11776 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011777 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11778 basic auth is supported.
11779
11780 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011781 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11782 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11783 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11784 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011785
11786http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011787 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11788 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011789 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11790 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011792method : integer + string
11793 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11794 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11795 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11796 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11797 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11798 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11799 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011801 ACL derivatives :
11802 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011804 Example :
11805 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11806 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11807 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011809path : string
11810 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11811 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11812 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11813 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11814 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11815 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11816 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011818 ACL derivatives :
11819 path : exact string match
11820 path_beg : prefix match
11821 path_dir : subdir match
11822 path_dom : domain match
11823 path_end : suffix match
11824 path_len : length match
11825 path_reg : regex match
11826 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011828req.ver : string
11829req_ver : string (deprecated)
11830 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11831 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11832 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011834 ACL derivatives :
11835 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011837res.comp : boolean
11838 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11839 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11840 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011842res.comp_algo : string
11843 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11844 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11845 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011847res.cook([<name>]) : string
11848scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11849 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11850 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11851 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011853 ACL derivatives :
11854 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011856res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11857scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11858 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11859 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11860 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011862res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11863scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11864 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11865 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11866 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011868res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11869 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11870 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11871 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11872 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11873 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11874 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11875 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11876 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11877 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011879res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11880 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11881 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11882 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11883 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11884 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011886res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11887shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11888 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11889 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11890 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11891 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11892 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11893 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11894 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11895 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011897 ACL derivatives :
11898 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11899 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11900 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11901 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11902 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11903 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11904 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11905 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11906
11907res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11908shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11909 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11910 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11911 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11912 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11913 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011915res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11916shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11917 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11918 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11919 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11920 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11921 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11922 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11925shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11926 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11927 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11928 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11929 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11930 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11931 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011933res.ver : string
11934resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11935 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11936 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011938 ACL derivatives :
11939 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011941set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11942 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11943 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11944 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11945 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011947 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11948 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011950 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011952status : integer
11953 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11954 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11955 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011957url : string
11958 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11959 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11960 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11961 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11962 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11963 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11964 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011966 ACL derivatives :
11967 url : exact string match
11968 url_beg : prefix match
11969 url_dir : subdir match
11970 url_dom : domain match
11971 url_end : suffix match
11972 url_len : length match
11973 url_reg : regex match
11974 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011976url_ip : ip
11977 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11978 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11979 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11980 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11981 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11982 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11983 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011985url_port : integer
11986 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11987 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11988 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11989 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011991urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11992url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11993 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11994 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11995 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11996 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11997 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11998 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11999 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12000 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12001 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012003 ACL derivatives :
12004 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12005 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12006 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12007 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12008 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12009 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12010 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12011 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012012
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012014 Example :
12015 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12016 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12017 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12018 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012020urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12021 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12022 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12023 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012024
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120267.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012027---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012029Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12030every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012031order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012033ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12034---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012035FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012036HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012037HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12038HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012039HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12040HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12041HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12042HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12043LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012044METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12045METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12046METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12047METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12048METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12049METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012050RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012051REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012052TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012053WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12054---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012055
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012056
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120578. Logging
12058----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012059
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012060One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12061provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12062very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12063provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12064state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012065to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012066headers.
12067
12068In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12069about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12070send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12071
12072 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12073 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12074 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12075 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12076 at the termination.
12077
12078The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12079allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12080as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12081while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12082real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12083delay.
12084
12085
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120868.1. Log levels
12087---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012088
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012089TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012090source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012091HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12092in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12093track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12094syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12095about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012096
12097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120988.2. Log formats
12099----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012100
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012101HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012102and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12103slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12104options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012105
12106 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12107 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12108 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12109 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12110 extents.
12111
12112 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12113 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12114 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12115 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12116 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12117
12118 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12119 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12120 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12121 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12122 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12123
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012124 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12125 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12126 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12127 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12128
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012129 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12130
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012131Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12132specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12133field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12134servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12135always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12136identifier.
12137
12138Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12139 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12140 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12141 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12142 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12143
12144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121458.2.1. Default log format
12146-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012147
12148This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12149as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12150format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12151
12152 Example :
12153 listen www
12154 mode http
12155 log global
12156 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12157
12158 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12159 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12160 (www/HTTP)
12161
12162 Field Format Extract from the example above
12163 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12164 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12165 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12166 4 'to' to
12167 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12168 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12169
12170Detailed fields description :
12171 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12172 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12173 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12174 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12175 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12176 and processed the connection.
12177 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12178
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012179In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12180"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12181connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12182
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012183It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12184will eventually disappear.
12185
12186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121878.2.2. TCP log format
12188---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012189
12190The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12191is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12192information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12193counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12194emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12195environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12196the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12197sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012198specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12199not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12200fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12201marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012202
12203 Example :
12204 frontend fnt
12205 mode tcp
12206 option tcplog
12207 log global
12208 default_backend bck
12209
12210 backend bck
12211 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12212
12213 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12214 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12215 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12216
12217 Field Format Extract from the example above
12218 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12219 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12220 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12221 4 frontend_name fnt
12222 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12223 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12224 7 bytes_read* 212
12225 8 termination_state --
12226 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12227 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12228
12229Detailed fields description :
12230 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012231 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12232 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12233 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12234 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12235 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012236
12237 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012238 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12239 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12240 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012241
12242 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12243 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12244 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12245 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12246
12247 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12248 and processed the connection.
12249
12250 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12251 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12252 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12253 applications.
12254
12255 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12256 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12257 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12258 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12259 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12260
12261 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12262 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12263 See "Timers" below for more details.
12264
12265 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12266 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12267 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12268 "Timers" below for more details.
12269
12270 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012271 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012272 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12273 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12274 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12275 details.
12276
12277 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12278 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12279 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12280 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12281 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12282
12283 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12284 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12285 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12286 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12287 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12288 for more details.
12289
12290 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012291 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012292 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12293 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12294 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012295 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012296
12297 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12298 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12299 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12300 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12301 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12302 caused by a denial of service attack.
12303
12304 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12305 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12306 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12307 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12308 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12309 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12310 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12311 denial of service attack.
12312
12313 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12314 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12315 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12316 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12317 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12318 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12319 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12320 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12321 be processed than on other servers.
12322
12323 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12324 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12325 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12326 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12327 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12328 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12329 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12330 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12331 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12332 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12333 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12334 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12335 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12336
12337 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12338 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12339 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12340 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12341 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12342 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12343 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12344 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12345
12346 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12347 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12348 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12349 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12350 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12351 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12352 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12353 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12354 occurs.
12355
12356
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123578.2.3. HTTP log format
12358----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012359
12360The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12361is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12362the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12363are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12364emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12365generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12366"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12367which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012368frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12369is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012370
12371Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12372slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12373with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12374
12375 Example :
12376 frontend http-in
12377 mode http
12378 option httplog
12379 log global
12380 default_backend bck
12381
12382 backend static
12383 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12384
12385 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12386 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12387 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012388 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012389
12390 Field Format Extract from the example above
12391 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12392 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12393 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12394 4 frontend_name http-in
12395 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12396 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12397 7 status_code 200
12398 8 bytes_read* 2750
12399 9 captured_request_cookie -
12400 10 captured_response_cookie -
12401 11 termination_state ----
12402 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12403 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12404 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12405 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12406 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012407
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012408
12409Detailed fields description :
12410 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012411 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12412 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12413 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12414 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12415 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012416
12417 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012418 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12419 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12420 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012421
12422 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12423 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12424 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12425 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12426 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12427
12428 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12429 and processed the connection.
12430
12431 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12432 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12433 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12434
12435 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12436 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12437 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12438 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12439 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12440 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12441
12442 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12443 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12444 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12445 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12446 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12447 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12448
12449 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12450 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12451 See "Timers" below for more details.
12452
12453 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12454 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12455 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12456 below for more details.
12457
12458 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12459 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12460 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12461 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12462 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12463 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12464 for more details.
12465
12466 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012467 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012468 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12469 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12470 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12471 details.
12472
12473 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12474 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12475 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12476
12477 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12478 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12479 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12480 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12481 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12482 overflowing.
12483
12484 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12485 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12486 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12487 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12488 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12489 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12490 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12491 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12492
12493 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12494 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12495 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12496 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12497 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12498 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12499 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12500 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12501
12502 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12503 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12504 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12505 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12506 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12507 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12508 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12509
12510 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012511 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012512 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12513 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12514 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012515 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012516 system.
12517
12518 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12519 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12520 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12521 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12522 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12523 caused by a denial of service attack.
12524
12525 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12526 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12527 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12528 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12529 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12530 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12531 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12532 denial of service attack.
12533
12534 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12535 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12536 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12537 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12538 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12539 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12540 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12541 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12542 processed than on other servers.
12543
12544 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12545 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12546 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12547 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12548 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12549 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12550 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12551 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12552 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12553 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12554 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12555 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12556 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12557
12558 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12559 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12560 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12561 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12562 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12563 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12564 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12565 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12566
12567 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12568 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12569 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12570 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12571 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12572 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12573 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12574 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12575 occurs.
12576
12577 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12578 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12579 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12580 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12581 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12582 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12583 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12584 cookies" below for more details.
12585
12586 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12587 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12588 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12589 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12590 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12591 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12592 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12593 and cookies" below for more details.
12594
12595 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12596 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12597 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12598 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12599 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12600 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12601 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12602 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12603
12604
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200126058.2.4. Custom log format
12606------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012607
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012608The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012609mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012610
12611HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12612Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12613separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12614prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12615
12616Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12617variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12618string formats ("Q").
12619
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012620If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012621as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012622less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12623the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12624
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012625Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012626In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012627in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012628
12629Flags are :
12630 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012631 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012632
12633 Example:
12634
12635 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12636 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12637
12638At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12639
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012640 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12641 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012642
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012643the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012644
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012645 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012646 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012647 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012648
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012649and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12650
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012651 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012652 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12653
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012654Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12655
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012656 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012657 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012658 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12659 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12660 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012661 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12662 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12663 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012664 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012665 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012666 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012667 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012668 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012669 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012670 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12671 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012672 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012673 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12674 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012675 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012676 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12677 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012678 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12679 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12680 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012681 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012682 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12683 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012684 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012685 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12686 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12687 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012688 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020012689 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012690 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12691 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12692 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12693 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012694 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012695 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012696 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012697 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012698 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012699 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012700 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12701 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12702 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012703 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012704 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12705 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012706 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012707 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012708 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012709 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012710
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012711 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012712
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012713
127148.2.5. Error log format
12715-----------------------
12716
12717When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12718protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12719By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12720"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12721will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12722logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12723
12724The format looks like this :
12725
12726 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12727 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12728 Connection error during SSL handshake
12729
12730 Field Format Extract from the example above
12731 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12732 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12733 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12734 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12735 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12736
12737These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12738failures.
12739
12740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127418.3. Advanced logging options
12742-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012743
12744Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12745just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12746options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12747for more information about their usage.
12748
12749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127508.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12751------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012752
12753It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12754haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12755commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12756monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12757ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12758
12759 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12760 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12761 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12762 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12763
12764 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12765 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12766 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012767 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012768 such as other load-balancers.
12769
12770 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12771 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12772 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12773
12774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127758.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12776----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012777
12778The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12779what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12780or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12781"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12782just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12783log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12784after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12785is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12786with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12787with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12788
12789
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12791------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012792
12793Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12794for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12795"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12796retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12797raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12798a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12799file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12800you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12801"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12802
12803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12805--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012806
12807Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12808multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12809them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12810"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12811logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12812error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12813and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12814too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12815useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12816alternative.
12817
12818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128198.4. Timing events
12820------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012821
12822Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12823reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12824the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12825frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12826mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12827
12828 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12829 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12830 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12831 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12832 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12833
12834 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12835 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12836 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12837 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12838 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12839
12840 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12841 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12842 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12843 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12844 connection never established.
12845
12846 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12847 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12848 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12849 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12850 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12851 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12852 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12853 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12854 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12855 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12856 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12857
12858 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12859 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12860 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12861 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012862 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012863
12864 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12865
12866 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12867 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12868 negative.
12869
12870These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12871protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12872that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012873due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012874close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12875session has been aborted on timeout.
12876
12877Most common cases :
12878
12879 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12880 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12881 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12882 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12883 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12884 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12885 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12886 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12887 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012888 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12889 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12890 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012891
12892 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12893 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12894 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12895 of ms on remote networks.
12896
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012897 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12898 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12899 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012900
12901 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12902 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12903 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12904 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12905 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12906 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12907 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12908 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12909 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12910 to the server until another one is released.
12911
12912Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12913
12914 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12915 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12916 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12917
12918 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12919 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12920 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12921
12922 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12923 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12924 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12925 flags.
12926
12927 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12928 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12929 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12930 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12931 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12932 the client connection was maintained open.
12933
12934 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012935 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012936 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12937 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12938
12939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129408.5. Session state at disconnection
12941-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012942
12943TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12944"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
129452-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12946each of which has a special meaning :
12947
12948 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12949 session to terminate :
12950
12951 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12952
12953 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12954 server explicitly refused it.
12955
12956 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12957 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12958 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12959 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012960 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12961
12962 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12963 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012964
12965 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12966 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12967 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12968 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12969 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12970
12971 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12972 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12973 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12974 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12975 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12976
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012977 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12978 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12979
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012980 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12981 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12982 backup connections when going up.
12983
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012984 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12985
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012986 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12987 send or receive data.
12988
12989 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12990 send or receive data.
12991
12992 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12993 with nothing left in the buffers.
12994
12995 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12996
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012997 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012998 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12999
13000 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13001 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13002 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13003 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13004 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13005
13006 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13007 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13008
13009 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13010 server (HTTP only).
13011
13012 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13013
13014 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13015 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13016 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13017
13018 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13019 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13020 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13021
13022 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13023
13024 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13025 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13026
13027 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13028 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13029 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13030
13031 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13032 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013033 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13034 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013035
13036 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13037 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13038 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13039 another server.
13040
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013041 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013042 server.
13043
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013044 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13045 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13046 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13047 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13048
13049 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13050 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13051 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13052 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13053
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013054 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13055 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13056 "use-server" rule).
13057
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013058 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13059
13060 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13061 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13062
13063 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13064
13065 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13066 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13067 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13068
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013069 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13070 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013071 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013072 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13073 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13074
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013075 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13076
13077 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13078 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13079
13080 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13081
13082 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13083
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013084The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13085was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013086helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13087starvation, attacks, etc...
13088
13089The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13090alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13091easier finding and understanding.
13092
13093 Flags Reason
13094
13095 -- Normal termination.
13096
13097 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13098 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13099 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13100 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13101
13102 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13103 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13104 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13105 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13106 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13107 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013109 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13110 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013111 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013112
13113 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13114 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13115 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13116
13117 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13118 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13119 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13120 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13121 the server takes too long to respond.
13122
13123 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13124 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13125 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13126 long a time to respond.
13127
13128 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13129 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13130 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13131 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13132 and the client.
13133
13134 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13135 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13136 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13137 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13138 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013139 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13140 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13141 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13142 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13143 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13144 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13145 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13146 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13147 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13148 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13149 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13150 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13151 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13152 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013153
13154 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13155 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013156 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13157 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13158 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13159 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013160
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013161 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13162 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13163
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013164 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013165 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13166 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13167 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13168 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13169 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13170
13171 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13172 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13173 503 or 504 here.
13174
13175 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13176 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13177 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13178 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13179 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13180
13181 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13182 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013183 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013184 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13185 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13186
13187 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13188 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13189 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13190 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13191 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13192 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13193 between haproxy and the server.
13194
13195 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13196 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13197 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13198 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13199 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13200 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13201 solution is to fix the application.
13202
13203 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13204 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13205 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13206 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13207 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13208 external attacks.
13209
13210 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13211 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013212 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013213 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13214 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13215
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013216 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13217 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13218 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013219 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13220 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013221
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013222 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13223 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13224 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13225 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013226 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13227 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13228 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13229 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13230 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013231
13232 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13233 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13234 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13235 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13236
13237 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13238 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13239 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13240 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13241
13242 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13243 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13244 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13245 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13246
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013247The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13248persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13249important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13250re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13251
13252 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13253
13254 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13255 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13256 set on a GET request.
13257
13258 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13259 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013260 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013261 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13262
13263 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13264 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13265 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13266
13267 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13268 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13269 already got a cookie.
13270
13271 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13272 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13273 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13274 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13275 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13276
13277 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13278 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13279 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13280
13281 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13282 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13283 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13284
13285 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13286 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13287
13288 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13289 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13290 then advertised in the response.
13291
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013292
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132938.6. Non-printable characters
13294-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013295
13296In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13297consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13298converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13299prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13300being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13301escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13302is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13303'}' when logging headers.
13304
13305Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13306issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13307containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13308
13309Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13310the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13311performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13312
13313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13315---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013316
13317Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13318achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013319section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013320cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13321the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13322the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013323locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013324not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13325user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13326a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13327wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13328
13329 Examples :
13330 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13331 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13332
13333 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13334 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13335
13336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133378.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13338---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013339
13340Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13341proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13342the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13343server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13344
13345Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13346response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013347section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013348
13349It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013350time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13351appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013352are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13353and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13354follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13355request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13356in the logs.
13357
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013358As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13359frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13360an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13361
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013362 Example :
13363 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13364 listen proxy-out
13365 mode http
13366 option httplog
13367 option logasap
13368 log global
13369 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13370
13371 # log the name of the virtual server
13372 capture request header Host len 20
13373
13374 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13375 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13376
13377 # log the beginning of the referrer
13378 capture request header Referer len 20
13379
13380 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13381 capture response header Server len 20
13382
13383 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13384 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13385
13386 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13387 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13388
13389 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13390 capture response header Via len 20
13391
13392 # log the URL location during a redirection
13393 capture response header Location len 20
13394
13395 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13396 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13397 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13398 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13399 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13400
13401 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13402 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13403 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13404 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013405 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013406
13407 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13408 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13409 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13410 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13411 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013412 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013413
13414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134158.9. Examples of logs
13416---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013417
13418These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13419them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13420reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13421
13422 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13423 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13424 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13425
13426 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13427 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13428
13429 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13430 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13431 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13432
13433 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13434 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13435
13436 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13437 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13438 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13439
13440 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013441 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013442 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13443 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13444
13445 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13446 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13447 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13448
13449 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13450 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013451 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013452 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13453 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13454 to return the 502 and not the server.
13455
13456 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013457 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013458
13459 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13460 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13461 Nothing was sent to any server.
13462
13463 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13464 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13465
13466 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13467 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13468 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13469 send a 408 return code to the client.
13470
13471 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13472 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13473
13474 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13475 5 seconds ("c----").
13476
13477 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13478 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013479 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013480
13481 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013482 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013483 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13484 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13485 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13486 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13487 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013488
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134909. Statistics and monitoring
13491----------------------------
13492
13493It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13494mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13495CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13496Unix socket.
13497
13498
134999.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013500---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013501
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013502The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013503page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13504begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13505represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13506use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13507('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13508(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13509text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13510do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13511use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013512
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013513In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13514that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13515S (Servers).
13516
13517 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13518 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13519 any name for server/listener)
13520 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13521 number queued without a server assigned.
13522 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13523 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13524 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13525 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13526 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13527 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13528 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13529 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13530 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13531 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13532 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13533 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13534 "option checkcache".
13535 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13536 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13537 - read error from the client
13538 - client timeout
13539 - client closed connection
13540 - various bad requests from the client.
13541 - request was tarpitted.
13542 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13543 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13544 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13545 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13546 active servers).
13547 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13548 Some other errors are:
13549 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13550 - failure applying filters to the response.
13551 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13552 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13553 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13554 switched away from.
13555 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13556 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13557 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13558 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13559 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13560 the server is up.)
13561 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13562 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13563 counters for each server.
13564 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13565 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13566 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13567 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13568 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13569 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13570 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13571 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13572 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13573 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13574 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13575 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13576 of times that server was selected.
13577 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13578 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13579 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13580 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13581 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13582 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013583 UNK -> unknown
13584 INI -> initializing
13585 SOCKERR -> socket error
13586 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13587 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13588 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13589 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13590 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13591 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13592 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13593 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13594 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13595 disable-on-404
13596 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13597 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13598 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013599 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13600 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13601 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13602 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13603 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13604 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13605 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13606 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13607 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13608 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13609 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13610 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13611 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13612 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13613 (inc. in eresp)
13614 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13615 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13616 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13617 (CPU/BW limit)
13618 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13619 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13620 server/backend
13621 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13622 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13623 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13624 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13625 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13626 (0 for TCP)
13627 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13628 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013629
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136319.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013632-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013633
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013634The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13635necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13636A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13637issuing commands by hand :
13638
13639 global
13640 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13641 stats timeout 2m
13642
13643It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13644the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13645never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13646situations :
13647
13648 global
13649 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13650 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13651 stats timeout 2m
13652
13653To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13654swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13655to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13656syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13657
13658 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13659 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13660
13661The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13662script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13663for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13664
13665The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13666that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13667editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13668(eg: watch a counter).
13669
13670The socket supports two operation modes :
13671 - interactive
13672 - non-interactive
13673
13674The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13675this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13676sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13677mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13678commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13679example :
13680
13681 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13682
13683The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13684entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13685for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13686sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13687"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13688after processing the last command of the same line.
13689
13690For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13691"prompt" command :
13692
13693 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13694 prompt
13695 > show info
13696 ...
13697 >
13698
13699Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13700delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13701that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13702parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013703
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013704It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13705on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13706own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013707
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013708The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13709If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13710all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13711it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13712
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013713add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013714 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13715 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13716 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13717 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013718
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013719add map <map> <key> <value>
13720 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13721 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013722 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13723 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13724 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013725
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013726clear counters
13727 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13728 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13729 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13730 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13731 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13732
13733clear counters all
13734 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13735 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13736 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13737
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013738clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013739 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13740 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13741 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013742
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013743clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013744 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13745 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13746 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013747
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013748clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13749 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13750
13751 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13752 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13753 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13754 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13755 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13756 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13757
13758 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13759
13760 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13761 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13762 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13763 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13764 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13765 the ACLs :
13766
13767 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13768 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13769 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13770 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13771 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13772 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13773
13774 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013775 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13776 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013777
13778 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013779 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013780 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013781 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13782 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13783 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13784 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013785
13786 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13787
13788 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013789 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013790 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13791 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013792 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13793 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13794 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013795
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013796del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13797 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013798 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13799 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13800 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13801 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013802
13803del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013804 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013805 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13806 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13807 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13808 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013809
13810disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013811 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13812
13813 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13814 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13815 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13816 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13817 re-enabled using enable agent.
13818
13819 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13820 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13821 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13822 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13823 otherwise unchanged.
13824
13825 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13826 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13827 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13828
13829 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13830 level "admin".
13831
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013832disable frontend <frontend>
13833 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13834 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13835 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13836 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13837 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13838 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13839 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13840 on the stats page.
13841
13842 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13843 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13844
13845 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13846 level "admin".
13847
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013848disable health <backend>/<server>
13849 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13850 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13851 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13852 agent check forces it down.
13853
13854 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13855 level "admin".
13856
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013857disable server <backend>/<server>
13858 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13859 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13860 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13861 during the maintenance.
13862
13863 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13864 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13865
13866 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013867 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013868
13869 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13870 level "admin".
13871
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013872enable agent <backend>/<server>
13873 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13874
13875 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13876 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13877
13878 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13879 level "admin".
13880
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013881enable frontend <frontend>
13882 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13883 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13884 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13885 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13886 which was disabled.
13887
13888 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13889 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13890
13891 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13892 level "admin".
13893
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013894enable health <backend>/<server>
13895 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13896 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13897
13898 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13899 level "admin".
13900
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013901enable server <backend>/<server>
13902 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13903 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13904
13905 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013906 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013907
13908 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13909 level "admin".
13910
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013911get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013912get acl <acl> <value>
13913 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13914 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13915 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13916 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13917 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013918
13919 The first two words are:
13920
13921 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13922 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13923 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13924
13925 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13926
13927 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13928
13929 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13930
13931 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13932 interpretation of the case.
13933
13934 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13935 useful with regular expressions.
13936
13937 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13938 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13939
13940 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13941 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13942 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13943
13944 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13945
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013946get weight <backend>/<server>
13947 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13948 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13949 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13950 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13951 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013952 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013953
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013954help
13955 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13956 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013957
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013958prompt
13959 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13960 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13961 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13962 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13963 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13964 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13965 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13966 command.
13967
13968quit
13969 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013970
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013971set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013972 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13973 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13974 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013975
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013976set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013977 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13978 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13979 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13980 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13981 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013982 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13983 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13984
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013985set maxconn global <maxconn>
13986 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13987 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13988 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13989 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13990 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13991 setting.
13992
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013993set rate-limit connections global <value>
13994 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13995 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13996 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13997 is passed in number of connections per second.
13998
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013999set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14000 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14001 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014002 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14003 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014004
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014005set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14006 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14007 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14008 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14009 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14010
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014011set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14012 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14013 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14014 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14015 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14016 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14017
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014018set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14019 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14020 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14021 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14022
14023set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14024 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14025 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14026 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14027
14028set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14029 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14030 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14031 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14032 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14033 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14034 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14035 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14036 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14037
14038set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14039 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14040 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14041
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014042set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14043 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14044 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14045 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14046 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14047
14048 Example:
14049 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14050 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14051 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14052 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14053
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014054set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014055 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14056 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14057 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14058 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014059 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14060 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014061
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014062set timeout cli <delay>
14063 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14064 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14065 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14066
14067set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14068 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14069 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014070 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14071 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14072 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14073 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14074 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14075 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14076 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14077 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14078 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14079 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14080 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14081 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14082 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014083
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014084show errors [<iid>]
14085 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14086 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014087 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14088 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14089 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014090
14091 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14092 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14093 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14094 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14095 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14096 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14097 are reported too.
14098
14099 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14100 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14101 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14102 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14103 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14104 code.
14105
14106 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14107 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14108 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14109 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14110 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14111 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14112 line.
14113
14114 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014115 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14116 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014117 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14118 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14119
14120 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14121 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14122 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14123 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14124 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14125 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14126 00204+ minal\r\n
14127 00211 \r\n
14128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014129 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014130 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14131 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14132 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14133 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14134 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14135 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014136
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014137show info
14138 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14139
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014140show map [<map>]
14141 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014142 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14143 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14144 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14145 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14146 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14147 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014148
14149show acl [<acl>]
14150 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014151 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14152 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14153 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14154 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14155 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014156
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014157show pools
14158 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14159 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14160 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14161 the pools.
14162
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014163show sess
14164 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014165 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14166 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14167
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014168show sess <id>
14169 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14170 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14171 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14172 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14173 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014174 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14175 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14176
14177 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14178 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014179
14180show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14181 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14182 possible to dump only selected items :
14183 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14184 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14185 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14186 for example:
14187 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14188 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14189 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14190
14191 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014192 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14193 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014194 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14195 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14196 Nbproc: 1
14197 Process_num: 1
14198 (...)
14199
14200 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14201 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14202 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14203 (...)
14204 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14205
14206 $
14207
14208 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14209 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14210 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14211 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014212 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014213
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014214show table
14215 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14216 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14217 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14218 entries currently in use.
14219
14220 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014221 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014222 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14223 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014224
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014225show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014226 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14227 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14228 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014229 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14230
14231 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14232 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14233 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14234 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14235 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14236
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014237 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14238 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14239 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14240 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14241 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14242 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14243
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014244
14245 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014246 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14247 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014248
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014249 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014250 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014251 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014252 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14253 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14254 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14255 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014256
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014257 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014258 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014259 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14260 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014261
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014262 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14263 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014264 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014265 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14266 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014267
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014268 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14269 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014270 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014271 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14272 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14273
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014274 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14275 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14276 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14277 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14278 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14279
14280 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14281 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14282 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014283 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14284 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014285 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14286 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014287
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014288shutdown frontend <frontend>
14289 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14290 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14291 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14292 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14293 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14294 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14295 once it is terminated.
14296
14297 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14298 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14299
14300 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14301 level "admin".
14302
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014303shutdown session <id>
14304 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14305 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14306 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14307 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14308 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14309 flag in the logs.
14310
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014311shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014312 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14313 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14314 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14315 'K' flag in the logs.
14316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014317/*
14318 * Local variables:
14319 * fill-column: 79
14320 * End:
14321 */